1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
10 //
11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
12 
13 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
14 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
15 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/DependenceFlags.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
21 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
22 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h"
23 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
24 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
28 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
29 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
30 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
31 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
32 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
33 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h"
34 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
35 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
37 #include <algorithm>
38 #include <cstdlib>
39 
40 using namespace clang;
41 using namespace sema;
42 
43 using AllowedExplicit = Sema::AllowedExplicit;
44 
45 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
46   return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) {
47     return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
48   });
49 }
50 
51 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
52 static ExprResult
53 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
54                       const Expr *Base, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
55                       SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
56                       const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
57   if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
58     return ExprError();
59   // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template
60   // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
61   // called on both.
62   // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
63   // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
64   // being used.
65   if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc))
66     return ExprError();
67   DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context)
68       DeclRefExpr(S.Context, Fn, false, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
69   if (HadMultipleCandidates)
70     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
71 
72   S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE, Base);
73   if (auto *FPT = DRE->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
74     if (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) {
75       S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT);
76       DRE->setType(Fn->getType());
77     }
78   }
79   return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()),
80                              CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
81 }
82 
83 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
84                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
85                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
86                                  bool CStyle,
87                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
88 
89 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
90                                                  QualType &ToType,
91                                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
92                                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
93                                                  bool CStyle);
94 static OverloadingResult
95 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
96                         UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
97                         OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
98                         AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
99                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
100 
101 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
102 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
103                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
104                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
105 
106 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
107 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
108                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
109                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
110 
111 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
112 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
113                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
114                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
115 
116 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
117 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
118 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
119   static const ImplicitConversionRank
120     Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
121     ICR_Exact_Match,
122     ICR_Exact_Match,
123     ICR_Exact_Match,
124     ICR_Exact_Match,
125     ICR_Exact_Match,
126     ICR_Exact_Match,
127     ICR_Promotion,
128     ICR_Promotion,
129     ICR_Promotion,
130     ICR_Conversion,
131     ICR_Conversion,
132     ICR_Conversion,
133     ICR_Conversion,
134     ICR_Conversion,
135     ICR_Conversion,
136     ICR_Conversion,
137     ICR_Conversion,
138     ICR_Conversion,
139     ICR_Conversion,
140     ICR_Conversion,
141     ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening,
142     ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
143     ICR_Conversion,
144     ICR_Conversion,
145     ICR_Writeback_Conversion,
146     ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right --
147                      // it was omitted by the patch that added
148                      // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion
149     ICR_C_Conversion,
150     ICR_C_Conversion_Extension
151   };
152   return Rank[(int)Kind];
153 }
154 
155 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
156 /// implicit conversion.
157 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
158   static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
159     "No conversion",
160     "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
161     "Array-to-pointer",
162     "Function-to-pointer",
163     "Function pointer conversion",
164     "Qualification",
165     "Integral promotion",
166     "Floating point promotion",
167     "Complex promotion",
168     "Integral conversion",
169     "Floating conversion",
170     "Complex conversion",
171     "Floating-integral conversion",
172     "Pointer conversion",
173     "Pointer-to-member conversion",
174     "Boolean conversion",
175     "Compatible-types conversion",
176     "Derived-to-base conversion",
177     "Vector conversion",
178     "SVE Vector conversion",
179     "Vector splat",
180     "Complex-real conversion",
181     "Block Pointer conversion",
182     "Transparent Union Conversion",
183     "Writeback conversion",
184     "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion",
185     "C specific type conversion",
186     "Incompatible pointer conversion"
187   };
188   return Name[Kind];
189 }
190 
191 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
192 /// sequence to the identity conversion.
193 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
194   First = ICK_Identity;
195   Second = ICK_Identity;
196   Third = ICK_Identity;
197   DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
198   QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
199   ReferenceBinding = false;
200   DirectBinding = false;
201   IsLvalueReference = true;
202   BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
203   BindsToRvalue = false;
204   BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
205   ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
206   CopyConstructor = nullptr;
207 }
208 
209 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
210 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
211 /// implicit conversions.
212 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
213   ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
214   if  (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
215     Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
216   if  (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
217     Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
218   if  (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
219     Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
220   return Rank;
221 }
222 
223 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
224 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
225 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
226 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
227 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
228   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
229   // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
230   // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
231   // a pointer.
232   if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
233       (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
234        getFromType()->isMemberPointerType() ||
235        getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
236        getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
237        First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
238     return true;
239 
240   return false;
241 }
242 
243 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
244 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
245 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
246 /// 13.3.3.2p4).
247 bool
248 StandardConversionSequence::
249 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
250   QualType FromType = getFromType();
251   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
252 
253   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
254   // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
255   // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
256   if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
257     FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
258 
259   if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
260     if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
261       return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
262 
263   return false;
264 }
265 
266 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
267 /// or after one in an implicit conversion.
268 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(ASTContext &Ctx,
269                                              const Expr *Converted) {
270   // We can have cleanups wrapping the converted expression; these need to be
271   // preserved so that destructors run if necessary.
272   if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Converted)) {
273     Expr *Inner =
274         const_cast<Expr *>(IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, EWC->getSubExpr()));
275     return ExprWithCleanups::Create(Ctx, Inner, EWC->cleanupsHaveSideEffects(),
276                                     EWC->getObjects());
277   }
278 
279   while (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
280     switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
281     case CK_NoOp:
282     case CK_IntegralCast:
283     case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
284     case CK_IntegralToFloating:
285     case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral:
286     case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
287     case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
288     case CK_FloatingCast:
289       Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
290       continue;
291 
292     default:
293       return Converted;
294     }
295   }
296 
297   return Converted;
298 }
299 
300 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
301 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
302 ///
303 /// \param Ctx  The AST context.
304 /// \param Converted  The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
305 /// \param ConstantValue  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
306 ///        value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
307 /// \param ConstantType  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
308 ///        type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
309 /// \param IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion If true type-narrowing conversions
310 ///        from floating point types to integral types should be ignored.
311 NarrowingKind StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(
312     ASTContext &Ctx, const Expr *Converted, APValue &ConstantValue,
313     QualType &ConstantType, bool IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) const {
314   assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
315 
316   // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
317   //   A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
318   QualType FromType = getToType(0);
319   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
320 
321   // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to
322   // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of
323   // the form 'Enum{init}'.
324   if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>())
325     ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
326 
327   switch (Second) {
328   // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it.
329   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
330     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType())
331       goto FloatingIntegralConversion;
332     if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
333       goto IntegralConversion;
334     // -- from a pointer type or pointer-to-member type to bool, or
335     return NK_Type_Narrowing;
336 
337   // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
338   //
339   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
340   //    type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
341   //    value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
342   //    the original value when converted back to the original type, or
343   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
344   FloatingIntegralConversion:
345     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
346       return NK_Type_Narrowing;
347     } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
348                ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
349       if (IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion)
350         return NK_Not_Narrowing;
351       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
352       assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression");
353 
354       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
355       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
356         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
357 
358       if (Optional<llvm::APSInt> IntConstantValue =
359               Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx)) {
360         // Convert the integer to the floating type.
361         llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
362         Result.convertFromAPInt(*IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue->isSigned(),
363                                 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
364         // And back.
365         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = *IntConstantValue;
366         bool ignored;
367         Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
368                                 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
369         // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
370         if (*IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
371           ConstantValue = APValue(*IntConstantValue);
372           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
373           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
374         }
375       } else {
376         // Variables are always narrowings.
377         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
378       }
379     }
380     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
381 
382   // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
383   //    where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
384   //    conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
385   //    if it cannot be represented exactly), or
386   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
387     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
388         Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
389       // FromType is larger than ToType.
390       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
391 
392       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
393       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
394         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
395 
396       if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
397         // Constant!
398         assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
399         llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
400         // Convert the source value into the target type.
401         bool ignored;
402         llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
403           Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
404           llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
405         // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
406         // values that can be represented.
407         if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
408           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
409           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
410         }
411       } else {
412         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
413       }
414     }
415     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
416 
417   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
418   //    that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
419   //    the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
420   //    conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
421   //    value when converted back to the original type.
422   case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
423   IntegralConversion: {
424     assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
425     assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
426     const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
427     const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
428     const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
429     const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
430 
431     if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
432         (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
433         (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
434       // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
435       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
436 
437       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
438       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
439         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
440 
441       Optional<llvm::APSInt> OptInitializerValue;
442       if (!(OptInitializerValue = Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx))) {
443         // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
444         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
445       }
446       llvm::APSInt &InitializerValue = *OptInitializerValue;
447       bool Narrowing = false;
448       if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
449         // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
450         // narrowing.
451         if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
452           Narrowing = true;
453       } else {
454         // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
455         // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
456         InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
457           InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
458         // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
459         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
460         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
461         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
462         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
463         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
464         // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
465         if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
466           Narrowing = true;
467       }
468       if (Narrowing) {
469         ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
470         ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
471         return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
472       }
473     }
474     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
475   }
476 
477   default:
478     // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
479     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
480   }
481 }
482 
483 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
484 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
485 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const {
486   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
487   bool PrintedSomething = false;
488   if (First != ICK_Identity) {
489     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
490     PrintedSomething = true;
491   }
492 
493   if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
494     if (PrintedSomething) {
495       OS << " -> ";
496     }
497     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
498 
499     if (CopyConstructor) {
500       OS << " (by copy constructor)";
501     } else if (DirectBinding) {
502       OS << " (direct reference binding)";
503     } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
504       OS << " (reference binding)";
505     }
506     PrintedSomething = true;
507   }
508 
509   if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
510     if (PrintedSomething) {
511       OS << " -> ";
512     }
513     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
514     PrintedSomething = true;
515   }
516 
517   if (!PrintedSomething) {
518     OS << "No conversions required";
519   }
520 }
521 
522 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
523 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
524 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const {
525   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
526   if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
527     Before.dump();
528     OS << " -> ";
529   }
530   if (ConversionFunction)
531     OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
532   else
533     OS << "aggregate initialization";
534   if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
535     OS << " -> ";
536     After.dump();
537   }
538 }
539 
540 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
541 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
542 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const {
543   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
544   if (isStdInitializerListElement())
545     OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: ";
546   switch (ConversionKind) {
547   case StandardConversion:
548     OS << "Standard conversion: ";
549     Standard.dump();
550     break;
551   case UserDefinedConversion:
552     OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
553     UserDefined.dump();
554     break;
555   case EllipsisConversion:
556     OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
557     break;
558   case AmbiguousConversion:
559     OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
560     break;
561   case BadConversion:
562     OS << "Bad conversion";
563     break;
564   }
565 
566   OS << "\n";
567 }
568 
569 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
570   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
571 }
572 
573 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
574   conversions().~ConversionSet();
575 }
576 
577 void
578 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
579   FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
580   ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
581   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
582 }
583 
584 namespace {
585   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
586   // template argument information.
587   struct DFIArguments {
588     TemplateArgument FirstArg;
589     TemplateArgument SecondArg;
590   };
591   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
592   // template parameter and template argument information.
593   struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
594     TemplateParameter Param;
595   };
596   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument
597   // information and the index of the problematic call argument.
598   struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments {
599     TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs;
600     unsigned CallArgIndex;
601   };
602   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store information about
603   // unsatisfied constraints.
604   struct CNSInfo {
605     TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs;
606     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
607   };
608 }
609 
610 /// Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
611 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
612 DeductionFailureInfo
613 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
614                                 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
615                                 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
616   DeductionFailureInfo Result;
617   Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
618   Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
619   switch (TDK) {
620   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
621   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
622   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
623   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
624   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
625   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
626     Result.Data = nullptr;
627     break;
628 
629   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
630   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
631     Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
632     break;
633 
634   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
635   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: {
636     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
637     auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs;
638     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
639     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
640     Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take();
641     Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex;
642     Result.Data = Saved;
643     break;
644   }
645 
646   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
647     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
648     DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
649     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
650     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
651     Result.Data = Saved;
652     break;
653   }
654 
655   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
656     // FIXME: It's slightly wasteful to allocate two TemplateArguments for this.
657   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
658   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
659     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
660     DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
661     Saved->Param = Info.Param;
662     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
663     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
664     Result.Data = Saved;
665     break;
666   }
667 
668   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
669     Result.Data = Info.take();
670     if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
671       PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
672           SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
673       Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
674       Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
675     }
676     break;
677 
678   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: {
679     CNSInfo *Saved = new (Context) CNSInfo;
680     Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take();
681     Saved->Satisfaction = Info.AssociatedConstraintsSatisfaction;
682     Result.Data = Saved;
683     break;
684   }
685 
686   case Sema::TDK_Success:
687   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
688     llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure");
689   }
690 
691   return Result;
692 }
693 
694 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
695   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
696   case Sema::TDK_Success:
697   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
698   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
699   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
700   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
701   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
702   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
703   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
704   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
705     break;
706 
707   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
708   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
709   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
710   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
711   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
712   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
713     // FIXME: Destroy the data?
714     Data = nullptr;
715     break;
716 
717   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
718     // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
719     Data = nullptr;
720     if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
721       Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
722       HasDiagnostic = false;
723     }
724     break;
725 
726   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
727     // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
728     Data = nullptr;
729     if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
730       Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
731       HasDiagnostic = false;
732     }
733     break;
734 
735   // Unhandled
736   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
737     break;
738   }
739 }
740 
741 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
742   if (HasDiagnostic)
743     return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
744   return nullptr;
745 }
746 
747 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
748   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
749   case Sema::TDK_Success:
750   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
751   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
752   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
753   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
754   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
755   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
756   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
757   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
758   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
759   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
760   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
761     return TemplateParameter();
762 
763   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
764   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
765     return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
766 
767   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
768   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
769   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
770     return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
771 
772   // Unhandled
773   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
774     break;
775   }
776 
777   return TemplateParameter();
778 }
779 
780 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
781   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
782   case Sema::TDK_Success:
783   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
784   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
785   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
786   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
787   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
788   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
789   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
790   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
791   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
792   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
793   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
794   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
795     return nullptr;
796 
797   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
798   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
799     return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs;
800 
801   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
802     return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
803 
804   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
805     return static_cast<CNSInfo*>(Data)->TemplateArgs;
806 
807   // Unhandled
808   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
809     break;
810   }
811 
812   return nullptr;
813 }
814 
815 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
816   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
817   case Sema::TDK_Success:
818   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
819   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
820   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
821   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
822   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
823   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
824   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
825   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
826   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
827   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
828     return nullptr;
829 
830   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
831   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
832   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
833   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
834   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
835   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
836     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
837 
838   // Unhandled
839   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
840     break;
841   }
842 
843   return nullptr;
844 }
845 
846 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
847   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
848   case Sema::TDK_Success:
849   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
850   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
851   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
852   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
853   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
854   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
855   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
856   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
857   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
858   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
859   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
860     return nullptr;
861 
862   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
863   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
864   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
865   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
866   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
867     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
868 
869   // Unhandled
870   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
871     break;
872   }
873 
874   return nullptr;
875 }
876 
877 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() {
878   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
879   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
880   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
881     return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex;
882 
883   default:
884     return llvm::None;
885   }
886 }
887 
888 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed(
889     OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
890   if (!AllowRewrittenCandidates)
891     return false;
892   return Op == OO_EqualEqual || Op == OO_Spaceship;
893 }
894 
895 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed(
896     ASTContext &Ctx, const FunctionDecl *FD) {
897   if (!shouldAddReversed(FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator()))
898     return false;
899   // Don't bother adding a reversed candidate that can never be a better
900   // match than the non-reversed version.
901   return FD->getNumParams() != 2 ||
902          !Ctx.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FD->getParamDecl(0)->getType(),
903                                      FD->getParamDecl(1)->getType()) ||
904          FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
905 }
906 
907 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
908   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
909     for (auto &C : i->Conversions)
910       C.~ImplicitConversionSequence();
911     if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
912       i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
913   }
914 }
915 
916 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear(CandidateSetKind CSK) {
917   destroyCandidates();
918   SlabAllocator.Reset();
919   NumInlineBytesUsed = 0;
920   Candidates.clear();
921   Functions.clear();
922   Kind = CSK;
923 }
924 
925 namespace {
926   class UnbridgedCastsSet {
927     struct Entry {
928       Expr **Addr;
929       Expr *Saved;
930     };
931     SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
932 
933   public:
934     void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
935       assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
936       Entry entry = { &E, E };
937       Entries.push_back(entry);
938       E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
939     }
940 
941     void restore() {
942       for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
943              i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
944         *i->Addr = i->Saved;
945     }
946   };
947 }
948 
949 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
950 /// preprocessing on the given expression.
951 ///
952 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
953 ///   without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
954 ///
955 /// Return true on unrecoverable error.
956 static bool
957 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
958                             UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) {
959   if (const BuiltinType *placeholder =  E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
960     // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
961     // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
962     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
963 
964     // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
965     // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
966     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
967         unbridgedCasts) {
968       unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
969       return false;
970     }
971 
972     // Go ahead and check everything else.
973     ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
974     if (result.isInvalid())
975       return true;
976 
977     E = result.get();
978     return false;
979   }
980 
981   // Nothing to do.
982   return false;
983 }
984 
985 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
986 /// placeholders.
987 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S,
988                                             MultiExprArg Args,
989                                             UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
990   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
991     if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged))
992       return true;
993 
994   return false;
995 }
996 
997 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the
998 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if
999 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as
1000 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't
1001 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or
1002 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be
1003 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying
1004 /// declaration.
1005 ///
1006 /// Example: Given the following input:
1007 ///
1008 ///   void f(int, float); // #1
1009 ///   void f(int, int); // #2
1010 ///   int f(int, int); // #3
1011 ///
1012 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload
1013 /// will not be used.
1014 ///
1015 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing
1016 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have
1017 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is
1018 /// unchanged.
1019 ///
1020 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare
1021 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then
1022 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of
1023 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and
1024 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
1025 ///
1026 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class
1027 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations
1028 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's
1029 /// signature.
1030 Sema::OverloadKind
1031 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
1032                     NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
1033   for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
1034          I != E; ++I) {
1035     NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
1036 
1037     bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
1038     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
1039       OldIsUsingDecl = true;
1040 
1041       // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
1042       // context, even if they have identical signatures.
1043       if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
1044 
1045       OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
1046     }
1047 
1048     // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration
1049     // if one of them is hidden.
1050     if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I))
1051       continue;
1052 
1053     // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
1054     // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
1055     // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
1056     // function templates hide function templates with different
1057     // return types or template parameter lists.
1058     bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
1059       (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
1060       !New->getFriendObjectKind();
1061 
1062     if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) {
1063       if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
1064         if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
1065           HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
1066           continue;
1067         }
1068 
1069         if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) &&
1070             !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
1071           continue;
1072 
1073         Match = *I;
1074         return Ovl_Match;
1075       }
1076 
1077       // Builtins that have custom typechecking or have a reference should
1078       // not be overloadable or redeclarable.
1079       if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(OldF)) {
1080         Match = *I;
1081         return Ovl_NonFunction;
1082       }
1083     } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) {
1084       // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
1085       // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
1086       assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
1087     } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
1088       // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
1089     } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
1090       // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
1091       // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
1092       // template instantiation.
1093       //
1094       // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class
1095       // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator.
1096       if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) {
1097         Match = *I;
1098         return Ovl_NonFunction;
1099       }
1100     } else {
1101       // (C++ 13p1):
1102       //   Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
1103       //   declarations cannot be overloaded.
1104       Match = *I;
1105       return Ovl_NonFunction;
1106     }
1107   }
1108 
1109   // C++ [temp.friend]p1:
1110   //   For a friend function declaration that is not a template declaration:
1111   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified or unqualified template-id,
1112   //       [...], otherwise
1113   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching
1114   //       non-template function is found in the specified class or namespace,
1115   //       the friend declaration refers to that function, otherwise,
1116   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching function
1117   //       template is found in the specified class or namespace, the friend
1118   //       declaration refers to the deduced specialization of that function
1119   //       template, otherwise
1120   //    -- the name shall be an unqualified-id [...]
1121   // If we get here for a qualified friend declaration, we've just reached the
1122   // third bullet. If the type of the friend is dependent, skip this lookup
1123   // until instantiation.
1124   if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && New->getQualifier() &&
1125       !New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
1126       !New->getDependentSpecializationInfo() &&
1127       !New->getType()->isDependentType()) {
1128     LookupResult TemplateSpecResult(LookupResult::Temporary, Old);
1129     TemplateSpecResult.addAllDecls(Old);
1130     if (CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(New, nullptr, TemplateSpecResult,
1131                                             /*QualifiedFriend*/true)) {
1132       New->setInvalidDecl();
1133       return Ovl_Overload;
1134     }
1135 
1136     Match = TemplateSpecResult.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>();
1137     return Ovl_Match;
1138   }
1139 
1140   return Ovl_Overload;
1141 }
1142 
1143 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
1144                       bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs,
1145                       bool ConsiderRequiresClauses) {
1146   // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded.
1147   if (New->isMain())
1148     return false;
1149 
1150   // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded.
1151   if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
1152     return false;
1153 
1154   FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
1155   FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
1156 
1157   // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
1158   //   A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
1159   //   and with normal (non-template) functions.
1160   if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr))
1161     return true;
1162 
1163   // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
1164   QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
1165   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
1166 
1167   // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
1168   // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
1169   // in the signature, they are overloads.
1170 
1171   // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
1172   // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1173   if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1174       isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1175     return false;
1176 
1177   const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1178   const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
1179 
1180   // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1181   // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1182   // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1183   if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1184       (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() ||
1185        OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
1186        !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
1187     return true;
1188 
1189   // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1190   //   The signature of a function template consists of its function
1191   //   signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1192   //   of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1193   //   relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1194   //   signature.
1195   //
1196   // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1197   // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
1198   //
1199   // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1200   // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1201   if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
1202       (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1203                                        OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1204                                        false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
1205        !Context.hasSameType(Old->getDeclaredReturnType(),
1206                             New->getDeclaredReturnType())))
1207     return true;
1208 
1209   // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
1210   // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
1211   //
1212   // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1213   // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1214   // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1215   // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1216   // can be overloaded.
1217   CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1218   CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
1219   if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
1220       !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1221     if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1222       if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules &&
1223           (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1224            NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1225         // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1226         //   - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1227         //     parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1228         //     declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1229         //     the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1230         //     them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
1231         Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
1232           << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
1233         Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1234       }
1235       return true;
1236     }
1237 
1238     // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1239     // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1240     // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1241     // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1242     auto OldQuals = OldMethod->getMethodQualifiers();
1243     auto NewQuals = NewMethod->getMethodQualifiers();
1244     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() &&
1245         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
1246       NewQuals.addConst();
1247     // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'.
1248     OldQuals.removeRestrict();
1249     NewQuals.removeRestrict();
1250     if (OldQuals != NewQuals)
1251       return true;
1252   }
1253 
1254   // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we
1255   // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function
1256   // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with
1257   // pass_object_size or it doesn't.
1258   if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) !=
1259       functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old))
1260     return true;
1261 
1262   // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature.
1263   for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr>
1264          NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1265          NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(),
1266          OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1267          OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>();
1268        NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) {
1269     if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE)
1270       return true;
1271     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1272     NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true);
1273     OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true);
1274     if (NewID != OldID)
1275       return true;
1276   }
1277 
1278   if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) {
1279     // Don't allow overloading of destructors.  (In theory we could, but it
1280     // would be a giant change to clang.)
1281     if (!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New)) {
1282       CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New),
1283                          OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old);
1284       if (NewTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) {
1285         assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) &&
1286                "Unexpected invalid target.");
1287 
1288         // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA
1289         // target attributes.
1290         if (NewTarget != OldTarget)
1291           return true;
1292       }
1293     }
1294   }
1295 
1296   if (ConsiderRequiresClauses) {
1297     Expr *NewRC = New->getTrailingRequiresClause(),
1298          *OldRC = Old->getTrailingRequiresClause();
1299     if ((NewRC != nullptr) != (OldRC != nullptr))
1300       // RC are most certainly different - these are overloads.
1301       return true;
1302 
1303     if (NewRC) {
1304       llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1305       NewRC->Profile(NewID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true);
1306       OldRC->Profile(OldID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true);
1307       if (NewID != OldID)
1308         // RCs are not equivalent - these are overloads.
1309         return true;
1310     }
1311   }
1312 
1313   // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1314   return false;
1315 }
1316 
1317 /// Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1318 ///
1319 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1320 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1321 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1322 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1323                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
1324                          AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1325                          bool InOverloadResolution,
1326                          bool CStyle,
1327                          bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1328                          bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1329   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1330 
1331   if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1332     // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1333     // we can perform.
1334     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1335     return ICS;
1336   }
1337 
1338   // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1339   OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(),
1340                                    OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
1341   switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
1342                                   Conversions, AllowExplicit,
1343                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) {
1344   case OR_Success:
1345   case OR_Deleted:
1346     ICS.setUserDefined();
1347     // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1348     //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1349     //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1350     //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1351     //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1352     //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1353     //   called for those cases.
1354     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1355           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1356       QualType FromCanon
1357         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1358       QualType ToCanon
1359         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1360       if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1361           (FromCanon == ToCanon ||
1362            S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1363         // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1364         // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1365         DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction;
1366         ICS.setStandard();
1367         ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1368         ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1369         ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1370         ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1371         ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found;
1372         if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1373           ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1374       }
1375     }
1376     break;
1377 
1378   case OR_Ambiguous:
1379     ICS.setAmbiguous();
1380     ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1381     ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1382     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1383          Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1384       if (Cand->Best)
1385         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function);
1386     break;
1387 
1388     // Fall through.
1389   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
1390     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1391     break;
1392   }
1393 
1394   return ICS;
1395 }
1396 
1397 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1398 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1399 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1400 /// to perform the initialization. Given
1401 ///
1402 ///   void f(float f);
1403 ///   void g(int i) { f(i); }
1404 ///
1405 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1406 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1407 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1408 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1409 //
1410 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1411 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1412 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1413 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1414 /// "BadConversion".
1415 ///
1416 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1417 /// not permitted.
1418 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1419 /// permitted.
1420 ///
1421 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1422 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1423 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
1424 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1425 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1426                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
1427                       AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1428                       bool InOverloadResolution,
1429                       bool CStyle,
1430                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1431                       bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1432   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1433   if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1434                            ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
1435     ICS.setStandard();
1436     return ICS;
1437   }
1438 
1439   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1440     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1441     return ICS;
1442   }
1443 
1444   // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1445   //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1446   //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1447   //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1448   //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1449   //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1450   //   called for those cases.
1451   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1452   if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
1453       (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1454        S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType, ToType))) {
1455     ICS.setStandard();
1456     ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1457     ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1458     ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1459 
1460     // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1461     // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1462     // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1463     // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1464     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1465 
1466     // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
1467     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1468       ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1469 
1470     return ICS;
1471   }
1472 
1473   return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1474                                   AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1475                                   AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1476                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
1477 }
1478 
1479 ImplicitConversionSequence
1480 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1481                             bool SuppressUserConversions,
1482                             AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1483                             bool InOverloadResolution,
1484                             bool CStyle,
1485                             bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1486   return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1487                                  AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1488                                  AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1489                                  /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1490 }
1491 
1492 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
1493 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
1494 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1495 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1496 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
1497 ExprResult Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1498                                            AssignmentAction Action,
1499                                            bool AllowExplicit) {
1500   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1501     return ExprError();
1502 
1503   // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1504   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
1505     = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
1506       (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
1507   if (getLangOpts().ObjC)
1508     CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType,
1509                                       From->getType(), From);
1510   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion(
1511       *this, From, ToType,
1512       /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1513       AllowExplicit ? AllowedExplicit::All : AllowedExplicit::None,
1514       /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
1515       /*CStyle=*/false, AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1516       /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1517   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1518 }
1519 
1520 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1521 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function
1522 /// type.
1523 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1524                                 QualType &ResultTy) {
1525   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1526     return false;
1527 
1528   // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1529   //                    or F(t noexcept) -> F(t)
1530   // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1531   //   - a pointer
1532   //   - a member pointer
1533   //   - a block pointer
1534   // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType.
1535   CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1536   CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1537   Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1538   if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1539   if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1540     if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1541       CanTo = CanTo.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1542       CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1543     } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1544       CanTo = CanTo.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1545       CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1546     } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1547       auto ToMPT = CanTo.castAs<MemberPointerType>();
1548       auto FromMPT = CanFrom.castAs<MemberPointerType>();
1549       // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function.
1550       if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass())
1551         return false;
1552       CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType();
1553       CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType();
1554     } else {
1555       return false;
1556     }
1557 
1558     TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1559     if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1560     if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1561       return false;
1562   }
1563 
1564   const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1565   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1566 
1567   const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo);
1568   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo();
1569 
1570   bool Changed = false;
1571 
1572   // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type.
1573   if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) {
1574     FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1575     Changed = true;
1576   }
1577 
1578   // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type.
1579   if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) {
1580     const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn);
1581     if (FromFPT->isNothrow() && !ToFPT->isNothrow()) {
1582       FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(
1583           Context.getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType(FromFPT, 0),
1584                                                    EST_None)
1585                  .getTypePtr());
1586       Changed = true;
1587     }
1588 
1589     // Convert FromFPT's ExtParameterInfo if necessary. The conversion is valid
1590     // only if the ExtParameterInfo lists of the two function prototypes can be
1591     // merged and the merged list is identical to ToFPT's ExtParameterInfo list.
1592     SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos;
1593     bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT;
1594     if (Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFPT, FromFPT, CanUseToFPT,
1595                                       CanUseFromFPT, NewParamInfos) &&
1596         CanUseToFPT && !CanUseFromFPT) {
1597       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ExtInfo = FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo();
1598       ExtInfo.ExtParameterInfos =
1599           NewParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : NewParamInfos.data();
1600       QualType QT = Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(),
1601                                             FromFPT->getParamTypes(), ExtInfo);
1602       FromFn = QT->getAs<FunctionType>();
1603       Changed = true;
1604     }
1605   }
1606 
1607   if (!Changed)
1608     return false;
1609 
1610   assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1611   if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1612 
1613   ResultTy = ToType;
1614   return true;
1615 }
1616 
1617 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1618 /// vector conversion.
1619 ///
1620 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1621 /// conversion.
1622 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
1623                                QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
1624   // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1625   // conversion.
1626   if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1627     return false;
1628 
1629   // Identical types require no conversions.
1630   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1631     return false;
1632 
1633   // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1634   if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1635     // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1636     // identity conversion.
1637     if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1638       return false;
1639 
1640     // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
1641     if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
1642       ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1643       return true;
1644     }
1645   }
1646 
1647   if (ToType->isSizelessBuiltinType() || FromType->isSizelessBuiltinType())
1648     if (S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1649         S.Context.areLaxCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
1650       ICK = ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion;
1651       return true;
1652     }
1653 
1654   // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1655   // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1656   // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1657   //   same size
1658   // 3)the destination type does not have the ARM MVE strict-polymorphism
1659   //   attribute, which inhibits lax vector conversion for overload resolution
1660   //   only
1661   if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1662     if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1663         (S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType) &&
1664          !ToType->hasAttr(attr::ArmMveStrictPolymorphism))) {
1665       ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1666       return true;
1667     }
1668   }
1669 
1670   return false;
1671 }
1672 
1673 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1674                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
1675                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1676                                 bool CStyle);
1677 
1678 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1679 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1680 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1681 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1682 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1683 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1684 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1685 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
1686 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1687                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
1688                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1689                                  bool CStyle,
1690                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1691   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1692 
1693   // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
1694   SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
1695   SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
1696   SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1697   SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1698 
1699   // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
1700   // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them.
1701   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1702       (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()))
1703     return false;
1704 
1705   // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1706   // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1707   // (C++ 4p1).
1708 
1709   if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1710     DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1711     if (FunctionDecl *Fn
1712           = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
1713                                                  AccessPair)) {
1714       // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1715       // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1716       FromType = Fn->getType();
1717       SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1718 
1719       // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1720       // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1721       if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1722                       S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1723         QualType resultTy;
1724         // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1725         if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType,
1726               S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1727           // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1728           if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1729             return false;
1730       }
1731 
1732       // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1733       // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1734       // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1735       // expression.
1736       CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1737       if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1738         assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1739                "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1740         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1741                == UO_AddrOf &&
1742                "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1743         const Type *ClassType
1744           = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1745         FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
1746       } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1747         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1748                UO_AddrOf &&
1749                "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1750         FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1751       }
1752 
1753       // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
1754       // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't
1755       // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block.
1756       assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1757         FromType,
1758         S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
1759     } else {
1760       return false;
1761     }
1762   }
1763   // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1764   //   A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1765   //   be converted to a prvalue.
1766   bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
1767   if (argIsLValue &&
1768       !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
1769       S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1770     SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
1771 
1772     // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1773     //   ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1774     //   of the type of the lvalue ...
1775     if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1776       FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1777 
1778     // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1779     // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
1780     // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1781     // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
1782     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1783   } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1784     // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
1785     SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
1786 
1787     // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1788     // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1789     // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
1790     FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
1791 
1792     if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
1793       // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4)
1794       SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
1795 
1796       // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1797       // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1798       // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1799       // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
1800       SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1801       SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1802       SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
1803       SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
1804       return true;
1805     }
1806   } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
1807     // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
1808     SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
1809 
1810     if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts()))
1811       if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()))
1812         if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD))
1813           return false;
1814 
1815     // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1816     // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1817     // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
1818     FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1819   } else {
1820     // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
1821     SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
1822   }
1823   SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
1824 
1825   // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1826   // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1827   // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1828   // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
1829   // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1830   // conversion.
1831   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
1832   ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
1833   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
1834     // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1835     // conversion to do.
1836     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1837   } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
1838     // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
1839     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
1840     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1841   } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1842     // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
1843     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
1844     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1845   } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1846     // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
1847     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1848     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1849   } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1850              (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1851               FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1852               FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1853               FromType->isMemberPointerType())) {
1854     // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1855     SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1856     FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
1857   } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1858              ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
1859     // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
1860     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
1861     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1862   } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) {
1863     // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
1864     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1865     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1866   } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1867              (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
1868     // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1869     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1870     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1871   } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
1872     // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if
1873     // their representation is different until there is back end support
1874     // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double.
1875 
1876     // Conversions between bfloat and other floats are not permitted.
1877     if (FromType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty || ToType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty)
1878       return false;
1879     if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) !=
1880         &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) {
1881       bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty &&
1882                                     ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) ||
1883                                    (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy &&
1884                                     ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty));
1885       if (Float128AndLongDouble &&
1886           (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) ==
1887            &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble()))
1888         return false;
1889     }
1890     // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1891     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1892     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1893   } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
1894               ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
1895              (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1896               ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
1897     // Conversions between bfloat and int are not permitted.
1898     if (FromType->isBFloat16Type() || ToType->isBFloat16Type())
1899       return false;
1900 
1901     // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
1902     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
1903     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1904   } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1905     SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1906   } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1907              S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1908     SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
1909   } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1910                                    FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1911     // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
1912     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
1913     SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
1914     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1915   } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
1916                                          InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
1917     // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
1918     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
1919   } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
1920     SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1921     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1922   } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1923              S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
1924     // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
1925     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1926     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1927   } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1928                                              InOverloadResolution,
1929                                              SCS, CStyle)) {
1930     SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1931     FromType = ToType;
1932   } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1933                                  CStyle)) {
1934     // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
1935     // appropriately.
1936     return true;
1937   } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1938              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1939              From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) {
1940     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1941     FromType = ToType;
1942   } else if (ToType->isQueueT() &&
1943              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1944              (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1945     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion;
1946     FromType = ToType;
1947   } else if (ToType->isSamplerT() &&
1948              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext())) {
1949     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1950     FromType = ToType;
1951   } else {
1952     // No second conversion required.
1953     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1954   }
1955   SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
1956 
1957   // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a
1958   // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]).
1959   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1960   if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1961     // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of
1962     // 'noreturn' (Clang extension).
1963     SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion;
1964   } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1965                                          ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
1966     SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1967     SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1968     FromType = ToType;
1969   } else {
1970     // No conversion required
1971     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1972   }
1973 
1974   // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
1975   //   [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1976   //   subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1977   //   a conversion. [...]
1978   QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1979   QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1980   if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
1981                                      == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
1982       CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
1983     FromType = ToType;
1984     CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1985   }
1986 
1987   SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
1988 
1989   if (CanonFrom == CanonTo)
1990     return true;
1991 
1992   // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1993   // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C.
1994   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution)
1995     return false;
1996 
1997   ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From};
1998   Sema::AssignConvertType Conv =
1999       S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER,
2000                                          /*Diagnose=*/false,
2001                                          /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false,
2002                                          /*ConvertRHS=*/false);
2003   ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv;
2004   switch (Conv) {
2005   case Sema::Compatible:
2006     SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion;
2007     break;
2008   // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an
2009   // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop
2010   // qualifiers, as well.
2011   case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
2012   case Sema::IncompatiblePointer:
2013   case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign:
2014     SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion;
2015     break;
2016   default:
2017     return false;
2018   }
2019 
2020   // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the
2021   // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the
2022   // function.
2023   SCS.Second = SecondConv;
2024   SCS.setToType(1, ToType);
2025 
2026   // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other
2027   // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just
2028   // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything
2029   // from making this ICK_Qualification.
2030   SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
2031   SCS.setToType(2, ToType);
2032   return true;
2033 }
2034 
2035 static bool
2036 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
2037                                      QualType &ToType,
2038                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
2039                                      StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2040                                      bool CStyle) {
2041 
2042   const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
2043   if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
2044     return false;
2045   // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
2046   RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
2047   // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
2048   for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) {
2049     if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
2050                              CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
2051       ToType = it->getType();
2052       return true;
2053     }
2054   }
2055   return false;
2056 }
2057 
2058 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
2059 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
2060 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
2061 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
2062 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2063   const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
2064   // All integers are built-in.
2065   if (!To) {
2066     return false;
2067   }
2068 
2069   // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
2070   // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
2071   // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
2072   // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
2073   // int (C++ 4.5p1).
2074   if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
2075       !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
2076     if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
2077         (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
2078          // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
2079          // less than int to an int.
2080          Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) {
2081       return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
2082     }
2083 
2084     return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
2085   }
2086 
2087   // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
2088   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
2089   //   fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
2090   //   following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
2091   //   (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
2092   //   unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
2093   //   long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
2094   //   values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
2095   //   type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
2096   //   with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
2097   //   long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
2098   //   there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
2099   // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
2100   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
2101   //   can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
2102   //   integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
2103   //   unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
2104   //   converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
2105   if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
2106     // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
2107     // provided for a scoped enumeration.
2108     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
2109       return false;
2110 
2111     // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
2112     // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting
2113     // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider
2114     // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression.
2115     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
2116       QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
2117       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
2118              IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType);
2119     }
2120 
2121     // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
2122     if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
2123         isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType))
2124       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2125           ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
2126 
2127     // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
2128     //   If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other
2129     //   value of that type for promotion purposes.
2130     //
2131     // ... so do not fall through into the bit-field checks below in C++.
2132     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
2133       return false;
2134   }
2135 
2136   // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
2137   //   A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
2138   //   to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
2139   //   represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
2140   //   long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
2141   //   If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
2142   //   underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
2143   //   or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
2144   //   type.
2145   if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
2146       ToType->isIntegerType()) {
2147     // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
2148     // unsigned.
2149     bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
2150     uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
2151 
2152     // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
2153     // order. Try each of these types.
2154     QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
2155       Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
2156       Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
2157       Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
2158     };
2159     for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
2160       uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
2161       if (FromSize < ToSize ||
2162           (FromSize == ToSize &&
2163            FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
2164         // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
2165         // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
2166         // promotion.
2167         return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
2168       }
2169     }
2170   }
2171 
2172   // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
2173   // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
2174   // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
2175   // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
2176   // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
2177   // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
2178   // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
2179   // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
2180   // conversion.
2181   //
2182   // FIXME: In C, only bit-fields of types _Bool, int, or unsigned int may be
2183   // promoted, per C11 6.3.1.1/2. We promote all bit-fields (including enum
2184   // bit-fields and those whose underlying type is larger than int) for GCC
2185   // compatibility.
2186   if (From) {
2187     if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) {
2188       Optional<llvm::APSInt> BitWidth;
2189       if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
2190           (BitWidth =
2191                MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) {
2192         llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth->getBitWidth(), BitWidth->isUnsigned());
2193         ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
2194 
2195         // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
2196         if (*BitWidth < ToSize ||
2197             (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
2198           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
2199         }
2200 
2201         // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
2202         // that fits into an unsigned int?
2203         if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize) {
2204           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
2205         }
2206 
2207         return false;
2208       }
2209     }
2210   }
2211 
2212   // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
2213   // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
2214   if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
2215     return true;
2216   }
2217 
2218   return false;
2219 }
2220 
2221 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
2222 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
2223 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
2224 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2225   if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
2226     if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
2227       /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
2228       /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
2229       if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
2230           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
2231         return true;
2232 
2233       // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
2234       //   When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
2235       //   double is promoted to long double [...].
2236       if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2237           (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
2238            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
2239           (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble ||
2240            ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128))
2241         return true;
2242 
2243       // Half can be promoted to float.
2244       if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
2245            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
2246           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
2247         return true;
2248     }
2249 
2250   return false;
2251 }
2252 
2253 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
2254 ///
2255 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
2256 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
2257 /// floating-point or integral promotion.
2258 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2259   const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
2260   if (!FromComplex)
2261     return false;
2262 
2263   const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
2264   if (!ToComplex)
2265     return false;
2266 
2267   return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
2268                                   ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
2269     IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(),
2270                         ToComplex->getElementType());
2271 }
2272 
2273 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
2274 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
2275 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
2276 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
2277 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
2278 ///
2279 static QualType
2280 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
2281                                    QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
2282                                    ASTContext &Context,
2283                                    bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
2284   assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
2285           FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
2286          "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
2287 
2288   /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
2289   if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
2290     return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
2291 
2292   QualType CanonFromPointee
2293     = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
2294   QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
2295   Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
2296 
2297   if (StripObjCLifetime)
2298     Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
2299 
2300   // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
2301   if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
2302     // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
2303     if (!ToType.isNull())
2304       return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
2305 
2306     // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
2307     // already.
2308     if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
2309       return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
2310     return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
2311   }
2312 
2313   // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
2314   QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
2315     = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
2316 
2317   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
2318     return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
2319   return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
2320 }
2321 
2322 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
2323                                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2324                                                ASTContext &Context) {
2325   // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
2326   // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
2327   if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
2328       Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
2329     return !InOverloadResolution;
2330 
2331   return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2332                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2333                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
2334 }
2335 
2336 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2337 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
2338 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
2339 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
2340 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
2341 /// ConvertedType.
2342 ///
2343 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
2344 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
2345 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
2346 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
2347 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
2348 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
2349 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
2350 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
2351 /// should result in a warning.
2352 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2353                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2354                                QualType& ConvertedType,
2355                                bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2356   IncompatibleObjC = false;
2357   if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2358                               IncompatibleObjC))
2359     return true;
2360 
2361   // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2362   if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
2363       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2364     ConvertedType = ToType;
2365     return true;
2366   }
2367 
2368   // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2369   if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
2370       ToType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
2371     ConvertedType = ToType;
2372     return true;
2373   }
2374   // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2375   // pointer type.
2376   if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
2377       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2378     ConvertedType = ToType;
2379     return true;
2380   }
2381 
2382   // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2383   // pointer constant.
2384   if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
2385       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2386     ConvertedType = ToType;
2387     return true;
2388   }
2389 
2390   const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
2391   if (!ToTypePtr)
2392     return false;
2393 
2394   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
2395   if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2396     ConvertedType = ToType;
2397     return true;
2398   }
2399 
2400   // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
2401   // , including objective-c pointers.
2402   QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2403   if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
2404       !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
2405     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2406                                       FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2407                                                        ToPointeeType,
2408                                                        ToType, Context);
2409     return true;
2410   }
2411   const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
2412   if (!FromTypePtr)
2413     return false;
2414 
2415   QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2416 
2417   // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
2418   // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2419   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2420     return false;
2421 
2422   // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2423   // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2424   // 4.10p2).
2425   if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2426       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2427     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2428                                                        ToPointeeType,
2429                                                        ToType, Context,
2430                                                    /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
2431     return true;
2432   }
2433 
2434   // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
2435   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
2436       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2437     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2438                                                        ToPointeeType,
2439                                                        ToType, Context);
2440     return true;
2441   }
2442 
2443   // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2444   // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
2445   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2446       Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2447     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2448                                                        ToPointeeType,
2449                                                        ToType, Context);
2450     return true;
2451   }
2452 
2453   // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
2454   //
2455   //   An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2456   //   can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2457   //   B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2458   //   (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2459   //   necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2460   //   conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2461   //   derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2462   //   the null pointer value of the destination type.
2463   //
2464   // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2465   // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
2466   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && FromPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2467       ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2468       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
2469       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2470     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2471                                                        ToPointeeType,
2472                                                        ToType, Context);
2473     return true;
2474   }
2475 
2476   if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2477       Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2478     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2479                                                        ToPointeeType,
2480                                                        ToType, Context);
2481     return true;
2482   }
2483 
2484   return false;
2485 }
2486 
2487 /// Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2488 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2489   Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2490 
2491   // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2492   if (TQs == Qs)
2493     return T;
2494 
2495   if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2496     return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2497 
2498   return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2499 }
2500 
2501 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2502 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2503 /// with the same arguments and return values.
2504 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2505                                    QualType& ConvertedType,
2506                                    bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2507   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC)
2508     return false;
2509 
2510   // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2511   Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2512 
2513   // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
2514   const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2515     ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2516   const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
2517     FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2518 
2519   if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
2520     // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2521     // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2522     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2523                                        FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2524       return false;
2525 
2526     // Conversion between Objective-C pointers.
2527     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
2528       const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2529       const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2530       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
2531           !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2532                                                 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2533         return false;
2534       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2535                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2536                                                          ToType, Context);
2537       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2538       return true;
2539     }
2540 
2541     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2542       // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2543       // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2544       // complain about it.
2545       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2546       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2547                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2548                                                          ToType, Context);
2549       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2550       return true;
2551     }
2552   }
2553   // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
2554   QualType ToPointeeType;
2555   if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2556     ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
2557   else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2558             ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
2559     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
2560     // to a block pointer type.
2561     if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2562       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2563       return true;
2564     }
2565     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2566   }
2567   else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
2568            ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2569     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
2570     // pointer to any object.
2571     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2572     return true;
2573   }
2574   else
2575     return false;
2576 
2577   QualType FromPointeeType;
2578   if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2579     FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
2580   else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2581            FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2582     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2583   else
2584     return false;
2585 
2586   // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2587   // is an Objective-C conversion.
2588   if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2589       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2590                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2591     // We always complain about this conversion.
2592     IncompatibleObjC = true;
2593     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2594     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2595     return true;
2596   }
2597   // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2598   // as in I* to id.
2599   if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2600       ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2601       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2602                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2603 
2604     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2605     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2606     return true;
2607   }
2608 
2609   // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
2610   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2611   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2612   // complain about it).
2613   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2614     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2615   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2616     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2617   if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2618     // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2619     // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2620     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2621           == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2622       return false;
2623 
2624     // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2625     // function types are obviously different.
2626     if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2627         FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2628         FromFunctionType->getMethodQuals() != ToFunctionType->getMethodQuals())
2629       return false;
2630 
2631     bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2632     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) ==
2633         Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2634       // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2635     } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2636                                        ToFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2637                                        ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2638       // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2639       HasObjCConversion = true;
2640     } else {
2641       // Function types are too different. Abort.
2642       return false;
2643     }
2644 
2645     // Check argument types.
2646     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2647          ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2648       QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2649       QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2650       if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2651             == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2652         // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2653       } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2654                                          ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2655         // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2656         HasObjCConversion = true;
2657       } else {
2658         // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2659         return false;
2660       }
2661     }
2662 
2663     if (HasObjCConversion) {
2664       // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2665       // conversion, but complain about it.
2666       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2667       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2668       return true;
2669     }
2670   }
2671 
2672   return false;
2673 }
2674 
2675 /// Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2676 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2677 ///
2678 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2679 ///
2680 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2681 ///
2682 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2683 /// this conversion.
2684 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2685                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2686   if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
2687       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2688     return false;
2689 
2690   // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2691   QualType ToPointee;
2692   if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2693     ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2694   else
2695     return false;
2696 
2697   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2698   if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2699       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
2700       !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
2701     return false;
2702 
2703   // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2704   QualType FromPointee;
2705   if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2706     FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2707   else
2708     return false;
2709 
2710   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2711   if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2712       (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2713        FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2714     return false;
2715 
2716   // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2717   FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2718   if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2719     return false;
2720 
2721   // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2722   // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2723   // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2724   FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2725 
2726   // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2727   ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2728   bool IncompatibleObjC;
2729   if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2730     FromPointee = ToPointee;
2731   else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2732                                     IncompatibleObjC))
2733     return false;
2734 
2735   /// Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2736   /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2737   FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2738   ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2739   return true;
2740 }
2741 
2742 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2743                                     QualType& ConvertedType) {
2744   QualType ToPointeeType;
2745   if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2746         ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2747     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2748   else
2749     return false;
2750 
2751   QualType FromPointeeType;
2752   if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2753       FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2754     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2755   else
2756     return false;
2757   // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2758   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2759   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2760 
2761   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2762     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2763   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2764     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2765 
2766   if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2767     return false;
2768 
2769   if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2770     return true;
2771 
2772   // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2773   // function types are obviously different.
2774   if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2775       FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2776     return false;
2777 
2778   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2779   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2780   if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2781     return false;
2782 
2783   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
2784   if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2785                           ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2786     // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2787   } else {
2788     QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType();
2789     QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType();
2790     if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2791         !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2792        LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2793 
2794      if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2795        // OK exact match.
2796      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2797                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2798      if (IncompatibleObjC)
2799        return false;
2800      // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2801      }
2802      else
2803        return false;
2804    }
2805 
2806    // Check argument types.
2807    for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2808         ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2809      IncompatibleObjC = false;
2810      QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2811      QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2812      if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2813        // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2814      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2815                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2816        if (IncompatibleObjC)
2817          return false;
2818        // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2819      } else
2820        // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2821        return false;
2822    }
2823 
2824    SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos;
2825    bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT;
2826    if (!Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFunctionType, FromFunctionType,
2827                                       CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT,
2828                                       NewParamInfos))
2829      return false;
2830 
2831    ConvertedType = ToType;
2832    return true;
2833 }
2834 
2835 enum {
2836   ft_default,
2837   ft_different_class,
2838   ft_parameter_arity,
2839   ft_parameter_mismatch,
2840   ft_return_type,
2841   ft_qualifer_mismatch,
2842   ft_noexcept
2843 };
2844 
2845 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles
2846 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly.
2847 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) {
2848   if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
2849     return FPT;
2850 
2851   if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
2852     return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2853 
2854   return nullptr;
2855 }
2856 
2857 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2858 /// function types.  Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2859 /// parameter types, and different return types.
2860 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2861                                       QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2862   // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2863   if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2864     PDiag << ft_default;
2865     return;
2866   }
2867 
2868   // Get the function type from the pointers.
2869   if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2870     const auto *FromMember = FromType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2871                *ToMember = ToType->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
2872     if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) {
2873       PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2874             << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2875       return;
2876     }
2877     FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2878     ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
2879   }
2880 
2881   if (FromType->isPointerType())
2882     FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2883   if (ToType->isPointerType())
2884     ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2885 
2886   // Remove references.
2887   FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2888   ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2889 
2890   // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2891   if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2892       !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2893     PDiag << ft_default;
2894     return;
2895   }
2896 
2897   // No extra info for same types.
2898   if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2899     PDiag << ft_default;
2900     return;
2901   }
2902 
2903   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType),
2904                           *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType);
2905 
2906   // Both types need to be function types.
2907   if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2908     PDiag << ft_default;
2909     return;
2910   }
2911 
2912   if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) {
2913     PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams()
2914           << FromFunction->getNumParams();
2915     return;
2916   }
2917 
2918   // Handle different parameter types.
2919   unsigned ArgPos;
2920   if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2921     PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2922           << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos)
2923           << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos);
2924     return;
2925   }
2926 
2927   // Handle different return type.
2928   if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(),
2929                            ToFunction->getReturnType())) {
2930     PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType()
2931           << FromFunction->getReturnType();
2932     return;
2933   }
2934 
2935   if (FromFunction->getMethodQuals() != ToFunction->getMethodQuals()) {
2936     PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToFunction->getMethodQuals()
2937           << FromFunction->getMethodQuals();
2938     return;
2939   }
2940 
2941   // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17
2942   // onwards).
2943   if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified())
2944           ->isNothrow() !=
2945       cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified())
2946           ->isNothrow()) {
2947     PDiag << ft_noexcept;
2948     return;
2949   }
2950 
2951   // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2952   PDiag << ft_default;
2953 }
2954 
2955 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
2956 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
2957 /// they have same number of arguments.  If the parameters are different,
2958 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
2959 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
2960                                       const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2961                                       unsigned *ArgPos) {
2962   for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(),
2963                                               N = NewType->param_type_begin(),
2964                                               E = OldType->param_type_end();
2965        O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2966     // Ignore address spaces in pointee type. This is to disallow overloading
2967     // on __ptr32/__ptr64 address spaces.
2968     QualType Old = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(O->getUnqualifiedType());
2969     QualType New = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(N->getUnqualifiedType());
2970 
2971     if (!Context.hasSameType(Old, New)) {
2972       if (ArgPos)
2973         *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin();
2974       return false;
2975     }
2976   }
2977   return true;
2978 }
2979 
2980 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2981 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
2982 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
2983 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2984 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2985 /// error, or returns false otherwise.
2986 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2987                                   CastKind &Kind,
2988                                   CXXCastPath& BasePath,
2989                                   bool IgnoreBaseAccess,
2990                                   bool Diagnose) {
2991   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2992   bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
2993 
2994   Kind = CK_BitCast;
2995 
2996   if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2997       From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2998           Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2999     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
3000       DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
3001                           PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
3002                             << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
3003     else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
3004       Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
3005         << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3006   }
3007   if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3008     if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3009       QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
3010                ToPointeeType   = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
3011 
3012       if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
3013           !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
3014         // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
3015         // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
3016         unsigned InaccessibleID = 0;
3017         unsigned AmbiguousID = 0;
3018         if (Diagnose) {
3019           InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base;
3020           AmbiguousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv;
3021         }
3022         if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(
3023                 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbiguousID,
3024                 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(),
3025                 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess))
3026           return true;
3027 
3028         // The conversion was successful.
3029         Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
3030       }
3031 
3032       if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
3033           FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
3034         assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
3035                "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!");
3036         Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj)
3037             << From->getSourceRange();
3038       }
3039     }
3040   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
3041                ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3042     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
3043           FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3044       // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
3045       // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
3046       // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
3047       if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
3048         return false;
3049     } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
3050       Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
3051     } else {
3052       Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
3053     }
3054   } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
3055     if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
3056       Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
3057   }
3058 
3059   // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
3060   // reasons.
3061   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
3062     Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
3063 
3064   return false;
3065 }
3066 
3067 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
3068 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
3069 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
3070 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
3071 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
3072 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
3073                                      QualType ToType,
3074                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
3075                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
3076   const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3077   if (!ToTypePtr)
3078     return false;
3079 
3080   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
3081   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
3082                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
3083                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
3084     ConvertedType = ToType;
3085     return true;
3086   }
3087 
3088   // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
3089   const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3090   if (!FromTypePtr)
3091     return false;
3092 
3093   // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
3094   // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
3095   QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
3096   QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
3097 
3098   if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
3099       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass)) {
3100     ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
3101                                                  ToClass.getTypePtr());
3102     return true;
3103   }
3104 
3105   return false;
3106 }
3107 
3108 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
3109 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
3110 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
3111 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
3112 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
3113 /// otherwise.
3114 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3115                                         CastKind &Kind,
3116                                         CXXCastPath &BasePath,
3117                                         bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
3118   QualType FromType = From->getType();
3119   const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3120   if (!FromPtrType) {
3121     // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
3122     assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
3123                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
3124            "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
3125     Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
3126     return false;
3127   }
3128 
3129   const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3130   assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
3131                       "that is not a member pointer.");
3132 
3133   QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
3134   QualType ToClass   = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
3135 
3136   // FIXME: What about dependent types?
3137   assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
3138   assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
3139 
3140   CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
3141                      /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
3142   bool DerivationOkay =
3143       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
3144   assert(DerivationOkay &&
3145          "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
3146   (void)DerivationOkay;
3147 
3148   if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
3149                                   getUnqualifiedType())) {
3150     std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
3151     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
3152       << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
3153     return true;
3154   }
3155 
3156   if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
3157     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
3158       << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
3159       << From->getSourceRange();
3160     return true;
3161   }
3162 
3163   if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
3164     CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
3165                          Paths.front(),
3166                          diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
3167 
3168   // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
3169   BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
3170   Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
3171   return false;
3172 }
3173 
3174 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given
3175 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial.
3176 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals,
3177                                                Qualifiers ToQuals) {
3178   // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial.
3179   if (ToQuals.hasConst() &&
3180       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone)
3181     return false;
3182 
3183   return true;
3184 }
3185 
3186 /// Perform a single iteration of the loop for checking if a qualification
3187 /// conversion is valid.
3188 ///
3189 /// Specifically, check whether any change between the qualifiers of \p
3190 /// FromType and \p ToType is permissible, given knowledge about whether every
3191 /// outer layer is const-qualified.
3192 static bool isQualificationConversionStep(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
3193                                           bool CStyle, bool IsTopLevel,
3194                                           bool &PreviousToQualsIncludeConst,
3195                                           bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
3196   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
3197   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
3198 
3199   // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void.
3200   if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType())
3201     FromQuals.removeUnaligned();
3202 
3203   // Objective-C ARC:
3204   //   Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
3205   if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime()) {
3206     if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
3207       if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals))
3208         ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3209       FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
3210       ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
3211     } else {
3212       // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
3213       // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
3214       return false;
3215     }
3216   }
3217 
3218   // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
3219   if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
3220       (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
3221     FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3222     ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3223   }
3224 
3225   //   -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
3226   //      2,j, and similarly for volatile.
3227   if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
3228     return false;
3229 
3230   // If address spaces mismatch:
3231   //  - in top level it is only valid to convert to addr space that is a
3232   //    superset in all cases apart from C-style casts where we allow
3233   //    conversions between overlapping address spaces.
3234   //  - in non-top levels it is not a valid conversion.
3235   if (ToQuals.getAddressSpace() != FromQuals.getAddressSpace() &&
3236       (!IsTopLevel ||
3237        !(ToQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(FromQuals) ||
3238          (CStyle && FromQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(ToQuals)))))
3239     return false;
3240 
3241   //   -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
3242   //      every cv for 0 < k < j.
3243   if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() &&
3244       !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
3245     return false;
3246 
3247   // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
3248   // include const.
3249   PreviousToQualsIncludeConst =
3250       PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
3251   return true;
3252 }
3253 
3254 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
3255 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
3256 /// (C++ 4.4).
3257 ///
3258 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
3259 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
3260 /// object lifetime.
3261 bool
3262 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
3263                                 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
3264   FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
3265   ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
3266   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
3267 
3268   // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
3269   // qualification conversion.
3270   if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
3271     return false;
3272 
3273   // (C++ 4.4p4):
3274   //   A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
3275   //   in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
3276   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
3277   bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
3278   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
3279     if (!isQualificationConversionStep(
3280             FromType, ToType, CStyle, !UnwrappedAnyPointer,
3281             PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, ObjCLifetimeConversion))
3282       return false;
3283     UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
3284   }
3285 
3286   // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
3287   // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
3288   // of times. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
3289   // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
3290   // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
3291   return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
3292 }
3293 
3294 /// - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
3295 /// atomic type.
3296 ///
3297 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
3298 /// sequence to finish the conversion.
3299 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3300                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
3301                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
3302                                 bool CStyle) {
3303   const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
3304   if (!ToAtomic)
3305     return false;
3306 
3307   StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
3308   if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
3309                             InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
3310                             CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
3311     return false;
3312 
3313   SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
3314   SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
3315   SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
3316   SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3317     = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
3318   SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
3319   return true;
3320 }
3321 
3322 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
3323                                               CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
3324                                               QualType Type) {
3325   const auto *CtorType = Constructor->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3326   if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) {
3327     QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0);
3328     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
3329       return true;
3330   }
3331   return false;
3332 }
3333 
3334 static OverloadingResult
3335 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3336                                        CXXRecordDecl *To,
3337                                        UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3338                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3339                                        bool AllowExplicit) {
3340   CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3341   for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) {
3342     auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D);
3343     if (!Info)
3344       continue;
3345 
3346     bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
3347                   S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor);
3348     if (Usable) {
3349       // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3350       // suppress conversions.
3351       bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3352           S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType);
3353       if (Info.ConstructorTmpl)
3354         S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl,
3355                                        /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From,
3356                                        CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3357                                        /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3358                                        AllowExplicit);
3359       else
3360         S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From,
3361                                CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3362                                /*PartialOverloading*/ false, AllowExplicit);
3363     }
3364   }
3365 
3366   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3367 
3368   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3369   switch (auto Result =
3370               CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) {
3371   case OR_Deleted:
3372   case OR_Success: {
3373     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3374     CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
3375     QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType();
3376     // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3377     User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3378     User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3379     User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3380     User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3381     User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3382     User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3383     User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3384     return Result;
3385   }
3386 
3387   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3388     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3389   case OR_Ambiguous:
3390     return OR_Ambiguous;
3391   }
3392 
3393   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3394 }
3395 
3396 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3397 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3398 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3399 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3400 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3401 /// false and User is unspecified.
3402 ///
3403 /// \param AllowExplicit  true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3404 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3405 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
3406 ///
3407 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should
3408 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit
3409 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set.
3410 static OverloadingResult
3411 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3412                         UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3413                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3414                         AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
3415                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
3416   assert(AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None ||
3417          !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3418   CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3419 
3420   // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3421   bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3422 
3423   // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3424   // constructors.
3425   if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3426     // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3427     //   When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3428     //   copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3429     //   derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3430     //   constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3431     //   functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3432     //   that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3433     //   the parentheses of the initializer.
3434     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
3435         (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
3436          S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), ToType)))
3437       ConstructorsOnly = true;
3438 
3439     if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) {
3440       // We're not going to find any constructors.
3441     } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3442                  = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
3443 
3444       Expr **Args = &From;
3445       unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3446       bool ListInitializing = false;
3447       if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3448         // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work.
3449         OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3450             S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet,
3451             AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3452         if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3453           return Result;
3454         // Never mind.
3455         CandidateSet.clear(
3456             OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3457 
3458         // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3459         // arguments, not the entire list.
3460         Args = InitList->getInits();
3461         NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3462         ListInitializing = true;
3463       }
3464 
3465       for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) {
3466         auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D);
3467         if (!Info)
3468           continue;
3469 
3470         bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3471         if (!ListInitializing)
3472           Usable = Usable && Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(
3473                                  /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
3474         if (Usable) {
3475           bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3476           if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3477             SuppressUserConversions = false;
3478             if (NumArgs == 1) {
3479               // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3480               // suppress conversions.
3481               SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3482                   S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType);
3483             }
3484           }
3485           if (Info.ConstructorTmpl)
3486             S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
3487                 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl,
3488                 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3489                 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3490                 /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3491                 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3492           else
3493             // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3494             // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
3495             S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl,
3496                                    llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3497                                    CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3498                                    /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3499                                    AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3500         }
3501       }
3502     }
3503   }
3504 
3505   // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
3506   if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3507   } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType())) {
3508     // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
3509   } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType =
3510                  From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3511     if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
3512          = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3513       // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
3514       const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3515       for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
3516         DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3517         NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
3518         CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3519         if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3520           D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3521 
3522         CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3523         FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
3524         if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3525           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3526         else
3527           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3528 
3529         if (ConvTemplate)
3530           S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
3531               ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType,
3532               CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
3533               AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None);
3534         else
3535           S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType,
3536                                    CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
3537                                    AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None);
3538       }
3539     }
3540   }
3541 
3542   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3543 
3544   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3545   switch (auto Result =
3546               CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) {
3547   case OR_Success:
3548   case OR_Deleted:
3549     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3550     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3551           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3552       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3553       //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3554       //   constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3555       //   sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3556       //   the argument of the constructor.
3557       //
3558       QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType();
3559       if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3560         // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3561         User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3562       } else {
3563         if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3564           User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3565         else {
3566           User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3567           User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3568         }
3569       }
3570       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3571       User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3572       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3573       User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3574       User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3575       User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3576       return Result;
3577     }
3578     if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3579                  = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3580       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3581       //
3582       //   [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3583       //   conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3584       //   conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3585       //   implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3586       User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3587       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3588       User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
3589       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3590       User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3591 
3592       // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3593       //   The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3594       //   result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3595       //   for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3596       //   is an initialization, the special rules for
3597       //   initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3598       //   selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3599       //   user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3600       //   13.3.3.1).
3601       User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3602       return Result;
3603     }
3604     llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
3605 
3606   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3607     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3608 
3609   case OR_Ambiguous:
3610     return OR_Ambiguous;
3611   }
3612 
3613   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3614 }
3615 
3616 bool
3617 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
3618   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3619   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(),
3620                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
3621   OverloadingResult OvResult =
3622     IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
3623                             CandidateSet, AllowedExplicit::None, false);
3624 
3625   if (!(OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ||
3626         (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())))
3627     return false;
3628 
3629   auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(
3630       *this,
3631       OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ? OCD_AmbiguousCandidates : OCD_AllCandidates,
3632       From);
3633   if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
3634     Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3635         << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3636   else { // OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()
3637     if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType,
3638                              diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete,
3639                              From->getType(), From->getSourceRange()))
3640       Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3641           << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType;
3642   }
3643 
3644   CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
3645                               *this, From, Cands);
3646   return true;
3647 }
3648 
3649 // Helper for compareConversionFunctions that gets the FunctionType that the
3650 // conversion-operator return  value 'points' to, or nullptr.
3651 static const FunctionType *
3652 getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(CXXConversionDecl *Conv) {
3653   const FunctionType *ConvFuncTy = Conv->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
3654   const PointerType *RetPtrTy =
3655       ConvFuncTy->getReturnType()->getAs<PointerType>();
3656 
3657   if (!RetPtrTy)
3658     return nullptr;
3659 
3660   return RetPtrTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
3661 }
3662 
3663 /// Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3664 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3665 /// is possible.
3666 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3667 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1,
3668                            FunctionDecl *Function2) {
3669   CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3670   CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3671   if (!Conv1 || !Conv2)
3672     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3673 
3674   if (!Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() || !Conv2->getParent()->isLambda())
3675     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3676 
3677   // Objective-C++:
3678   //   If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3679   //   a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3680   //   respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3681   //   because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3682   //   to keep code working.
3683   if (S.getLangOpts().ObjC && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
3684     bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3685     bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3686     if (Block1 != Block2)
3687       return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3688                     : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3689   }
3690 
3691   // In order to support multiple calling conventions for the lambda conversion
3692   // operator (such as when the free and member function calling convention is
3693   // different), prefer the 'free' mechanism, followed by the calling-convention
3694   // of operator(). The latter is in place to support the MSVC-like solution of
3695   // defining ALL of the possible conversions in regards to calling-convention.
3696   const FunctionType *Conv1FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv1);
3697   const FunctionType *Conv2FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv2);
3698 
3699   if (Conv1FuncRet && Conv2FuncRet &&
3700       Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv() != Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv()) {
3701     CallingConv Conv1CC = Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv();
3702     CallingConv Conv2CC = Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv();
3703 
3704     CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = Conv2->getParent()->getLambdaCallOperator();
3705     const FunctionProtoType *CallOpProto =
3706         CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3707 
3708     CallingConv CallOpCC =
3709         CallOp->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
3710     CallingConv DefaultFree = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(
3711         CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/false);
3712     CallingConv DefaultMember = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(
3713         CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/true);
3714 
3715     CallingConv PrefOrder[] = {DefaultFree, DefaultMember, CallOpCC};
3716     for (CallingConv CC : PrefOrder) {
3717       if (Conv1CC == CC)
3718         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3719       if (Conv2CC == CC)
3720         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3721     }
3722   }
3723 
3724   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3725 }
3726 
3727 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(
3728     const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
3729   return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) ||
3730          (ICS.isUserDefined() &&
3731           ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr);
3732 }
3733 
3734 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3735 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3736 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
3737 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3738 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
3739                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3740                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
3741 {
3742   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3743   // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3744   //   -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3745   //      conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3746   //      an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3747   //   -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3748   //      conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3749   //      (13.3.3.1.3).
3750   //
3751   // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3752   //   For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3753   //   described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3754   //   treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3755   //   from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
3756 
3757   // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has
3758   // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at
3759   // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse
3760   // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the
3761   // standard. For example:
3762   //
3763   // int &f(...);    // #1
3764   // void f(char*);  // #2
3765   // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); }
3766   //
3767   // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function.
3768   // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis
3769   // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there
3770   // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't
3771   // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11.
3772   // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued
3773   // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11.
3774 
3775   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
3776       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) !=
3777       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2))
3778     return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1)
3779                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3780                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3781 
3782   if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3783     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3784   if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
3785     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3786 
3787   // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3788   // the same kind.
3789   if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3790     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3791 
3792   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3793       ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3794 
3795   // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3796   // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3797   // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3798 
3799   // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3800   // list-initialization sequence L2 if:
3801   // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or,
3802   //   if not that,
3803   // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T",
3804   //   and N1 is smaller than N2.,
3805   // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply.
3806   if (!ICS1.isBad()) {
3807     if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3808         !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3809       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3810     if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3811         ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3812       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3813   }
3814 
3815   if (ICS1.isStandard())
3816     // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than
3817     // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...]
3818     Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
3819                                                 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
3820   else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
3821     // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3822     // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3823     // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3824     // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3825     // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3826     // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3827     if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
3828           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
3829       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
3830                                                   ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3831                                                   ICS2.UserDefined.After);
3832     else
3833       Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3834                                           ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3835                                           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
3836   }
3837 
3838   return Result;
3839 }
3840 
3841 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3842 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3843 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3844 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3845                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3846                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3847   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3848     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3849 
3850   // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
3851   // any non-identity conversion sequence
3852   if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3853     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3854   else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3855     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3856 
3857   if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3858     if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3859       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3860     else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3861       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3862     else
3863       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3864   } else if (!Context.hasSimilarType(SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
3865     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3866 
3867   if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3868     return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3869                              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3870   }
3871 
3872   if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3873     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3874              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3875              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3876 
3877   if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3878     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3879              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3880              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3881 
3882   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3883 }
3884 
3885 /// Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3886 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3887 static bool
3888 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3889                              const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3890   // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3891   //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3892   //      implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
3893   //      without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
3894   //      to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
3895   //      lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
3896   //      reference*.
3897   //
3898   // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3899   // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3900   // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3901   // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3902   // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
3903   if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3904       SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3905     return false;
3906 
3907   return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3908           SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3909          (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3910           !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue);
3911 }
3912 
3913 enum class FixedEnumPromotion {
3914   None,
3915   ToUnderlyingType,
3916   ToPromotedUnderlyingType
3917 };
3918 
3919 /// Returns kind of fixed enum promotion the \a SCS uses.
3920 static FixedEnumPromotion
3921 getFixedEnumPromtion(Sema &S, const StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
3922 
3923   if (SCS.Second != ICK_Integral_Promotion)
3924     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3925 
3926   QualType FromType = SCS.getFromType();
3927   if (!FromType->isEnumeralType())
3928     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3929 
3930   EnumDecl *Enum = FromType->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl();
3931   if (!Enum->isFixed())
3932     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3933 
3934   QualType UnderlyingType = Enum->getIntegerType();
3935   if (S.Context.hasSameType(SCS.getToType(1), UnderlyingType))
3936     return FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType;
3937 
3938   return FixedEnumPromotion::ToPromotedUnderlyingType;
3939 }
3940 
3941 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3942 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3943 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3944 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3945 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
3946                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3947                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
3948 {
3949   // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3950   // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3951 
3952   //  -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3953   //     sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3954   //     excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3955   //     sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3956   //     non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
3957   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
3958         = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
3959     return CK;
3960 
3961   //  -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3962   //     defined below), or, if not that,
3963   ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3964   ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3965   if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3966     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3967   else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3968     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3969 
3970   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3971   // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3972   // applies:
3973 
3974   //   A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3975   //   pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3976   //   that is such a conversion.
3977   if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3978     return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3979              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3980              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3981 
3982   // C++14 [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3983   // This is retroactively applied to C++11 by CWG 1601.
3984   //
3985   //   A conversion that promotes an enumeration whose underlying type is fixed
3986   //   to its underlying type is better than one that promotes to the promoted
3987   //   underlying type, if the two are different.
3988   FixedEnumPromotion FEP1 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS1);
3989   FixedEnumPromotion FEP2 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS2);
3990   if (FEP1 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && FEP2 != FixedEnumPromotion::None &&
3991       FEP1 != FEP2)
3992     return FEP1 == FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType
3993                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3994                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3995 
3996   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3997   //
3998   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
3999   //   conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
4000   //   void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
4001   //   of B* to void*.
4002   bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
4003     = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
4004   bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
4005     = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
4006   if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
4007     // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
4008     // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
4009     return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4010                               : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4011   } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
4012     // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
4013     // their derived-to-base conversions.
4014     if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
4015           = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2))
4016       return DerivedCK;
4017   } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
4018              !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
4019     // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
4020     // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
4021     // inheritance relationship in their sources.
4022     QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
4023     QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
4024 
4025     // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
4026     // conversion, if we need to.
4027     if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4028       FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
4029     if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4030       FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
4031 
4032     QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4033     QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4034 
4035     if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4036       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4037     else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4038       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4039 
4040     // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
4041     // other, it is the better one.
4042     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
4043       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4044     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
4045       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4046     if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
4047       bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
4048                                                           FromObjCPtr2);
4049       bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
4050                                                            FromObjCPtr1);
4051       if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
4052         return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4053                          : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4054       }
4055     }
4056   }
4057 
4058   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
4059     // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
4060     if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
4061       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4062     else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
4063       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4064   }
4065 
4066   // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
4067   // bullet 3).
4068   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
4069         = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
4070     return QualCK;
4071 
4072   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
4073     // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
4074     //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
4075     //      which the references refer are the same type except for
4076     //      top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
4077     //      initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
4078     //      to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
4079     QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
4080     QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
4081     T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
4082     T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
4083     Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4084     QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4085     QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4086     if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4087       // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
4088       // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
4089       if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
4090                                           SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
4091         return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
4092                                            ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4093                                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4094       }
4095 
4096       // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
4097       // type for comparison.
4098       if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
4099         T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
4100       if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
4101         T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
4102       if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
4103         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4104       if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
4105         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4106     }
4107   }
4108 
4109   // In Microsoft mode (below 19.28), prefer an integral conversion to a
4110   // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
4111   // is between types of the same size.
4112   // For example:
4113   // void f(float);
4114   // void f(int);
4115   // int main {
4116   //    long a;
4117   //    f(a);
4118   // }
4119   // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
4120   // as clang will do in standard mode.
4121   if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
4122       !S.getLangOpts().isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2019_8) &&
4123       SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
4124       SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
4125       S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
4126           S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
4127     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4128 
4129   // Prefer a compatible vector conversion over a lax vector conversion
4130   // For example:
4131   //
4132   // typedef float __v4sf __attribute__((__vector_size__(16)));
4133   // void f(vector float);
4134   // void f(vector signed int);
4135   // int main() {
4136   //   __v4sf a;
4137   //   f(a);
4138   // }
4139   // Here, we'd like to choose f(vector float) and not
4140   // report an ambiguous call error
4141   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion &&
4142       SCS2.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion) {
4143     bool SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(
4144         SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2));
4145     bool SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(
4146         SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2));
4147 
4148     if (SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion != SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion)
4149       return SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion
4150                  ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4151                  : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4152   }
4153 
4154   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion &&
4155       SCS2.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion) {
4156     bool SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion =
4157         S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2));
4158     bool SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion =
4159         S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2));
4160 
4161     if (SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion !=
4162         SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion)
4163       return SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion
4164                  ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4165                  : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4166   }
4167 
4168   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4169 }
4170 
4171 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
4172 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
4173 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
4174 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
4175 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
4176                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
4177                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
4178   // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
4179   //  -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
4180   //     yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
4181   //     cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
4182   //     the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
4183   //     deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
4184   if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
4185       SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
4186     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4187 
4188   // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
4189   // conversion (!)
4190   QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
4191   QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
4192   T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
4193   T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
4194   assert(!T1->isReferenceType() && !T2->isReferenceType());
4195   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4196   QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4197   QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4198 
4199   // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapping
4200   // them.
4201   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
4202     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4203 
4204   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
4205     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4206 
4207   // Objective-C++ ARC:
4208   //   Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
4209   //   to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
4210   if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
4211                                       SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
4212     Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
4213                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4214                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4215   }
4216 
4217   while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)) {
4218     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
4219     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
4220     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
4221     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
4222     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
4223     // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
4224     // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
4225     // strict subset of qualifiers.
4226     if (T1.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime() ==
4227         T2.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime())
4228       // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
4229       // about how the sequences rank.
4230       // ObjC ownership quals are omitted above as they interfere with
4231       // the ARC overload rule.
4232       ;
4233     else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
4234       // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
4235       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4236         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
4237         // qualifiers.
4238         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4239 
4240       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4241     } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
4242       // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
4243       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
4244         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
4245         // qualifiers.
4246         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4247 
4248       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4249     } else {
4250       // Qualifiers are disjoint.
4251       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4252     }
4253 
4254     // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
4255     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
4256       break;
4257   }
4258 
4259   // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
4260   // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
4261   switch (Result) {
4262   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
4263     if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
4264       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4265     break;
4266 
4267   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
4268     break;
4269 
4270   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
4271     if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
4272       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4273     break;
4274   }
4275 
4276   return Result;
4277 }
4278 
4279 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
4280 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
4281 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
4282 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3).  As part of these checks, we also look at
4283 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
4284 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
4285 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
4286                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
4287                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
4288   QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
4289   QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
4290   QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
4291   QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
4292 
4293   // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
4294   // conversion, if we need to.
4295   if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4296     FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
4297   if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4298     FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
4299 
4300   // Canonicalize all of the types.
4301   FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
4302   ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
4303   FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
4304   ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
4305 
4306   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
4307   //
4308   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
4309   //   class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
4310   //
4311   // Compare based on pointer conversions.
4312   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4313       SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4314       /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
4315       FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
4316       ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
4317     QualType FromPointee1 =
4318         FromType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4319     QualType ToPointee1 =
4320         ToType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4321     QualType FromPointee2 =
4322         FromType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4323     QualType ToPointee2 =
4324         ToType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4325 
4326     //   -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
4327     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
4328       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
4329         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4330       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
4331         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4332     }
4333 
4334     //   -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
4335     if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
4336       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4337         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4338       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4339         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4340     }
4341   } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4342              SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
4343     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
4344       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4345     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
4346       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4347     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
4348       = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4349     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
4350       = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4351 
4352     if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
4353       // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
4354       // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
4355       // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
4356       // Objective-C pointer types.
4357       bool FromAssignLeft
4358         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
4359       bool FromAssignRight
4360         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
4361       bool ToAssignLeft
4362         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
4363       bool ToAssignRight
4364         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
4365 
4366       // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
4367       // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
4368       if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
4369           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
4370         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4371       if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
4372           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
4373         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4374 
4375       // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
4376       // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
4377       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
4378         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4379       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
4380         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4381 
4382       // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
4383       // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
4384       if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
4385           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
4386         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4387       if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
4388           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
4389         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4390 
4391       // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
4392       // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
4393       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
4394         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4395       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
4396         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4397 
4398       //   -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
4399       if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4400           !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
4401           (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) {
4402         if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) {
4403           // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to
4404           // C *.
4405           bool IsFirstSame =
4406               FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl();
4407           bool IsSecondSame =
4408               FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl();
4409           if (IsFirstSame) {
4410             if (!IsSecondSame)
4411               return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4412           } else if (IsSecondSame)
4413             return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4414         }
4415         return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4416                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4417       }
4418 
4419       //   -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
4420       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
4421           (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
4422         return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4423         : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4424     }
4425   }
4426 
4427   // Ranking of member-pointer types.
4428   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
4429       FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
4430       ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
4431     const auto *FromMemPointer1 = FromType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4432     const auto *ToMemPointer1 = ToType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4433     const auto *FromMemPointer2 = FromType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4434     const auto *ToMemPointer2 = ToType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4435     const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
4436     const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
4437     const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
4438     const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
4439     QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4440     QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4441     QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4442     QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4443     // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
4444     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
4445       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
4446         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4447       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
4448         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4449     }
4450     // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
4451     if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
4452       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4453         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4454       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4455         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4456     }
4457   }
4458 
4459   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4460     //   -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
4461     //   -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
4462     //      B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
4463     //      reference of type A&,
4464     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4465         !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
4466       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2))
4467         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4468       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1))
4469         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4470     }
4471 
4472     //   -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
4473     //   -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
4474     //      A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
4475     //      reference of type A&,
4476     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4477         S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
4478       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1))
4479         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4480       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2))
4481         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4482     }
4483   }
4484 
4485   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4486 }
4487 
4488 /// Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
4489 /// C++ class.
4490 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
4491   if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
4492     return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
4493 
4494   return true;
4495 }
4496 
4497 static QualType withoutUnaligned(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) {
4498   if (!T.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned())
4499     return T;
4500 
4501   Qualifiers Q;
4502   T = Ctx.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T, Q);
4503   Q.removeUnaligned();
4504   return Ctx.getQualifiedType(T, Q);
4505 }
4506 
4507 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
4508 /// determine whether they are reference-compatible,
4509 /// reference-related, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
4510 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
4511 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
4512 /// type being initialized.
4513 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
4514 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
4515                                    QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
4516                                    ReferenceConversions *ConvOut) {
4517   assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
4518     "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
4519   assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
4520 
4521   QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
4522   QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
4523   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4524   QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4525   QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4526 
4527   ReferenceConversions ConvTmp;
4528   ReferenceConversions &Conv = ConvOut ? *ConvOut : ConvTmp;
4529   Conv = ReferenceConversions();
4530 
4531   // C++2a [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4532   //   Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
4533   //   reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is similar to T2, or
4534   //   T1 is a base class of T2.
4535   //   "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if
4536   //   a prvalue of type "pointer to cv2 T2" can be converted to the type
4537   //   "pointer to cv1 T1" via a standard conversion sequence.
4538 
4539   // Check for standard conversions we can apply to pointers: derived-to-base
4540   // conversions, ObjC pointer conversions, and function pointer conversions.
4541   // (Qualification conversions are checked last.)
4542   QualType ConvertedT2;
4543   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4544     // Nothing to do.
4545   } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) &&
4546              isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
4547              IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
4548     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase;
4549   else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4550            UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4551            Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
4552     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjC;
4553   else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() &&
4554            IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2)) {
4555     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Function;
4556     // No need to check qualifiers; function types don't have them.
4557     return Ref_Compatible;
4558   }
4559   bool ConvertedReferent = Conv != 0;
4560 
4561   // We can have a qualification conversion. Compute whether the types are
4562   // similar at the same time.
4563   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
4564   bool TopLevel = true;
4565   do {
4566     if (T1 == T2)
4567       break;
4568 
4569     // We will need a qualification conversion.
4570     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Qualification;
4571 
4572     // Track whether we performed a qualification conversion anywhere other
4573     // than the top level. This matters for ranking reference bindings in
4574     // overload resolution.
4575     if (!TopLevel)
4576       Conv |= ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification;
4577 
4578     // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same.
4579     T1 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T1);
4580     T2 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T2);
4581 
4582     // If we find a qualifier mismatch, the types are not reference-compatible,
4583     // but are still be reference-related if they're similar.
4584     bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4585     if (!isQualificationConversionStep(T2, T1, /*CStyle=*/false, TopLevel,
4586                                        PreviousToQualsIncludeConst,
4587                                        ObjCLifetimeConversion))
4588       return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSimilarType(T1, T2))
4589                  ? Ref_Related
4590                  : Ref_Incompatible;
4591 
4592     // FIXME: Should we track this for any level other than the first?
4593     if (ObjCLifetimeConversion)
4594       Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime;
4595 
4596     TopLevel = false;
4597   } while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2));
4598 
4599   // At this point, if the types are reference-related, we must either have the
4600   // same inner type (ignoring qualifiers), or must have already worked out how
4601   // to convert the referent.
4602   return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
4603              ? Ref_Compatible
4604              : Ref_Incompatible;
4605 }
4606 
4607 /// Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible
4608 ///        with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4609 static bool
4610 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4611                          QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4612                          Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4613                          bool AllowExplicit) {
4614   assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4615   auto *T2RecordDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4616 
4617   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(
4618       DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
4619   const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4620   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
4621     NamedDecl *D = *I;
4622     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4623     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4624       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4625 
4626     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4627       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4628     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4629     if (ConvTemplate)
4630       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4631     else
4632       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4633 
4634     if (AllowRvalues) {
4635       // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4636       // functions that return lvalues.
4637       if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4638         const ReferenceType *RefType
4639           = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4640         if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4641           continue;
4642       }
4643 
4644       if (!ConvTemplate &&
4645           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4646               DeclLoc,
4647               Conv->getConversionType()
4648                   .getNonReferenceType()
4649                   .getUnqualifiedType(),
4650               DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType()) ==
4651               Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
4652         continue;
4653     } else {
4654       // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4655       // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4656       // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4657 
4658       const ReferenceType *RefType =
4659         Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4660       if (!RefType ||
4661           (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4662            !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4663         continue;
4664     }
4665 
4666     if (ConvTemplate)
4667       S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
4668           ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4669           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit);
4670     else
4671       S.AddConversionCandidate(
4672           Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4673           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit);
4674   }
4675 
4676   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4677 
4678   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
4679   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best)) {
4680   case OR_Success:
4681     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4682     //
4683     //   [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4684     //   applying a conversion function to the argument
4685     //   expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4686     //   user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4687     //   second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4688     //   conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4689     //   entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4690     //   type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4691     if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4692       return false;
4693 
4694     ICS.setUserDefined();
4695     ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4696     ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
4697     ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
4698     ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
4699     ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
4700     ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4701     assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4702            ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4703            "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4704     return true;
4705 
4706   case OR_Ambiguous:
4707     ICS.setAmbiguous();
4708     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4709          Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4710       if (Cand->Best)
4711         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function);
4712     return true;
4713 
4714   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4715   case OR_Deleted:
4716     // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4717     // conversion; continue with other checks.
4718     return false;
4719   }
4720 
4721   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
4722 }
4723 
4724 /// Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4725 /// initialization.
4726 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4727 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
4728                  SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4729                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
4730                  bool AllowExplicit) {
4731   assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4732 
4733   // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4734   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4735   ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4736 
4737   QualType T1 = DeclType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4738   QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4739 
4740   // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4741   // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4742   // type of the resulting function.
4743   if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4744     DeclAccessPair Found;
4745     if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4746                                                                 false, Found))
4747       T2 = Fn->getType();
4748   }
4749 
4750   // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4751   bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4752   Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
4753 
4754   Sema::ReferenceConversions RefConv;
4755   Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship =
4756       S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, &RefConv);
4757 
4758   auto SetAsReferenceBinding = [&](bool BindsDirectly) {
4759     ICS.setStandard();
4760     ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
4761     // FIXME: A reference binding can be a function conversion too. We should
4762     // consider that when ordering reference-to-function bindings.
4763     ICS.Standard.Second = (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase)
4764                               ? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4765                               : (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjC)
4766                                     ? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4767                                     : ICK_Identity;
4768     // FIXME: As a speculative fix to a defect introduced by CWG2352, we rank
4769     // a reference binding that performs a non-top-level qualification
4770     // conversion as a qualification conversion, not as an identity conversion.
4771     ICS.Standard.Third = (RefConv &
4772                               Sema::ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification)
4773                              ? ICK_Qualification
4774                              : ICK_Identity;
4775     ICS.Standard.setFromType(T2);
4776     ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4777     ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4778     ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4779     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4780     ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = BindsDirectly;
4781     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4782     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4783     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
4784     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4785     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding =
4786         (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime) != 0;
4787     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
4788     ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
4789   };
4790 
4791   // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4792   //   A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4793   //   of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4794 
4795   //     -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
4796   if (!isRValRef) {
4797     //     -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4798     //        reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4799     //
4800     // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4801     if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) {
4802       // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4803       //   When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4804       //   to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4805       //   is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4806       //   has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4807       //   in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4808       //   derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4809       SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/true);
4810 
4811       // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4812       // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4813       // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4814       // [over.best.ics]p2).
4815       return ICS;
4816     }
4817 
4818     //       -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4819     //          not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4820     //          converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4821     //          is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4822     //          conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4823     //          conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4824     //          one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4825     if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
4826         S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) &&
4827         RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
4828       if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4829                                    Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4830                                    AllowExplicit))
4831         return ICS;
4832     }
4833   }
4834 
4835   //     -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4836   //        non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
4837   //        shall be an rvalue reference.
4838   if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4839     if (InitCategory.isRValue() && RefRelationship != Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
4840       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType);
4841     return ICS;
4842   }
4843 
4844   //       -- If the initializer expression
4845   //
4846   //            -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
4847   //               lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
4848   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible &&
4849       (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4850        (InitCategory.isPRValue() &&
4851           (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4852        (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4853     // In C++11, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4854     // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4855     // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4856     // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4857     // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
4858     SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
4859                           !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType()));
4860     return ICS;
4861   }
4862 
4863   //            -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4864   //               reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
4865   //               an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4866   //               "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
4867   //               "cv3 T3",
4868   //
4869   //          then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
4870   //          expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
4871   //          in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
4872   //          class subobject).
4873   if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4874       T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) &&
4875       FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4876                                Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4877                                AllowExplicit)) {
4878     // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4879     // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4880     // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4881     // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
4882     if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
4883         ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4884       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4885 
4886     return ICS;
4887   }
4888 
4889   // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try.
4890   if (T1->isFunctionType())
4891     return ICS;
4892 
4893   //       -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4894   //          initialized from the initializer expression using the
4895   //          rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4896   //          reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4897   //          reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4898   //          cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4899   //          cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4900   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4901     // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4902     // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4903     // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4904     // initialization fails.
4905     //
4906     // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4907     // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important.
4908     Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4909     Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4910     T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4911     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4912     T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4913     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4914     // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same.
4915     T1Quals.removeUnaligned();
4916     T2Quals.removeUnaligned();
4917     if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4918       return ICS;
4919   }
4920 
4921   // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4922   // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4923   // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4924   // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4925   // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4926   if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4927       (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4928     return ICS;
4929 
4930   // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4931   // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4932   if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && isRValRef &&
4933       Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) {
4934     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, Init, DeclType);
4935     return ICS;
4936   }
4937 
4938   // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
4939   //   When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4940   //   an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4941   //   required to convert the argument expression to the
4942   //   underlying type of the reference according to
4943   //   13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4944   //   to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4945   //   the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4946   //   cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4947   //   and does not constitute a conversion.
4948   ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4949                               AllowedExplicit::None,
4950                               /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4951                               /*CStyle=*/false,
4952                               /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4953                               /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4954 
4955   // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4956   if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4957     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4958     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4959     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4960     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
4961     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4962     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4963   } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
4964     const ReferenceType *LValRefType =
4965         ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType()
4966             ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4967 
4968     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3:
4969     //   Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a
4970     //   standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...]
4971     //   binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function
4972     //   lvalue.
4973     // Note that the function case is not possible here.
4974     if (isRValRef && LValRefType) {
4975       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4976       return ICS;
4977     }
4978 
4979     ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
4980     ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4981     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4982     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType;
4983     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4984     ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4985   }
4986 
4987   return ICS;
4988 }
4989 
4990 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4991 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4992                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
4993                       bool InOverloadResolution,
4994                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4995                       bool AllowExplicit = false);
4996 
4997 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4998 /// initializer list From.
4999 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5000 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
5001                   bool SuppressUserConversions,
5002                   bool InOverloadResolution,
5003                   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
5004   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
5005   //   When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
5006   //   special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
5007 
5008   ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
5009   Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
5010 
5011   // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
5012   // initialized from init lists.
5013   if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType))
5014     return Result;
5015 
5016   // Per DR1467:
5017   //   If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single
5018   //   element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the
5019   //   implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element
5020   //   to the parameter type.
5021   //
5022   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ]
5023   //   and the initializer list has a single element that is an
5024   //   appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the
5025   //   implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion.
5026   if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
5027     if (ToType->isRecordType()) {
5028       QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType();
5029       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) ||
5030           S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), InitType, ToType))
5031         return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
5032                                      SuppressUserConversions,
5033                                      InOverloadResolution,
5034                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5035     }
5036 
5037     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)) {
5038       if (S.IsStringInit(From->getInit(0), AT)) {
5039         InitializedEntity Entity =
5040           InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
5041                                                  /*Consumed=*/false);
5042         if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) {
5043           Result.setStandard();
5044           Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5045           Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5046           Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5047           return Result;
5048         }
5049       }
5050     }
5051   }
5052 
5053   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below).
5054   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
5055   //   If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
5056   //   all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
5057   //   conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
5058   //   element of the list to X.
5059   //
5060   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3:
5061   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer
5062   //   list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is
5063   //   default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list
5064   //   can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is
5065   //   the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X.
5066   //
5067   // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks.
5068   bool toStdInitializerList = false;
5069   QualType X;
5070   if (ToType->isArrayType())
5071     X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
5072   else
5073     toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
5074   if (!X.isNull()) {
5075     for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
5076       Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
5077       ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5078           TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
5079                                 InOverloadResolution,
5080                                 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5081       // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
5082       if (ICS.isBad()) {
5083         Result = ICS;
5084         break;
5085       }
5086       // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
5087       if (Result.isBad() || CompareImplicitConversionSequences(
5088                                 S, From->getBeginLoc(), ICS, Result) ==
5089                                 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
5090         Result = ICS;
5091     }
5092 
5093     // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
5094     // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
5095     if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
5096       Result.setStandard();
5097       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5098       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5099       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5100     }
5101 
5102     Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
5103     return Result;
5104   }
5105 
5106   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4:
5107   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
5108   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
5109   //   resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
5110   //   conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
5111   //   constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
5112   //   implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
5113   if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
5114     // This function can deal with initializer lists.
5115     return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
5116                                     AllowedExplicit::None,
5117                                     InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
5118                                     AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5119                                     /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5120   }
5121 
5122   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5:
5123   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
5124   //   Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
5125   //   initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
5126   //   sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
5127   if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
5128     // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
5129     // down to checking whether the initialization works.
5130     // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
5131     InitializedEntity Entity =
5132         InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
5133                                                /*Consumed=*/false);
5134     if (S.CanPerformAggregateInitializationForOverloadResolution(Entity,
5135                                                                  From)) {
5136       Result.setUserDefined();
5137       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
5138       // Initializer lists don't have a type.
5139       Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
5140       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
5141 
5142       Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5143       Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
5144       Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5145       Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr;
5146     }
5147     return Result;
5148   }
5149 
5150   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6:
5151   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
5152   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
5153   if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
5154     // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
5155     // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
5156     // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
5157 
5158     QualType T1 = ToType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5159 
5160     // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
5161     // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
5162     if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
5163       Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
5164 
5165       QualType T2 = Init->getType();
5166 
5167       // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
5168       // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
5169       // type of the resulting function.
5170       if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
5171         DeclAccessPair Found;
5172         if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
5173                                    Init, ToType, false, Found))
5174           T2 = Fn->getType();
5175       }
5176 
5177       // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
5178       Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship =
5179           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getBeginLoc(), T1, T2);
5180 
5181       if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) {
5182         return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/ From->getBeginLoc(),
5183                                 SuppressUserConversions,
5184                                 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
5185       }
5186     }
5187 
5188     // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
5189     // initializer list.
5190     Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
5191                                InOverloadResolution,
5192                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5193     if (Result.isFailure())
5194       return Result;
5195     assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
5196            "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
5197 
5198     // Can we even bind to a temporary?
5199     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
5200         (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
5201       StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
5202                                             Result.UserDefined.After;
5203       SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
5204       SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
5205       SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
5206       SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
5207       SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
5208       SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
5209     } else
5210       Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
5211                     From, ToType);
5212     return Result;
5213   }
5214 
5215   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7:
5216   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
5217   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
5218   if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
5219     //    - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an
5220     //      initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one
5221     //      required to convert the element to the parameter type.
5222     unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
5223     if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0)))
5224       Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
5225                                      SuppressUserConversions,
5226                                      InOverloadResolution,
5227                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5228     //    - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
5229     //      sequence is the identity conversion.
5230     else if (NumInits == 0) {
5231       Result.setStandard();
5232       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5233       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5234       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5235     }
5236     return Result;
5237   }
5238 
5239   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8:
5240   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
5241   //   In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
5242   return Result;
5243 }
5244 
5245 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
5246 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
5247 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
5248 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
5249 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
5250 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
5251 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5252 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5253                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
5254                       bool InOverloadResolution,
5255                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5256                       bool AllowExplicit) {
5257   if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
5258     return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
5259                              InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5260 
5261   if (ToType->isReferenceType())
5262     return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
5263                             /*FIXME:*/ From->getBeginLoc(),
5264                             SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit);
5265 
5266   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
5267                                SuppressUserConversions,
5268                                AllowedExplicit::None,
5269                                InOverloadResolution,
5270                                /*CStyle=*/false,
5271                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5272                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5273 }
5274 
5275 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
5276                                   const CanQualType ToQTy,
5277                                   Sema &S,
5278                                   SourceLocation Loc,
5279                                   ExprValueKind FromVK) {
5280   OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
5281   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5282     TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
5283 
5284   return !ICS.isBad();
5285 }
5286 
5287 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
5288 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
5289 /// expression @p From.
5290 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5291 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType,
5292                                 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
5293                                 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
5294                                 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
5295   QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
5296   // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
5297   //                 const volatile object.
5298   Qualifiers Quals = Method->getMethodQualifiers();
5299   if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method)) {
5300     Quals.addConst();
5301     Quals.addVolatile();
5302   }
5303 
5304   QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
5305 
5306   // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
5307   // to exit early.
5308   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
5309 
5310   // We need to have an object of class type.
5311   if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5312     FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
5313 
5314     // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
5315     // better have an lvalue.
5316     assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
5317   }
5318 
5319   assert(FromType->isRecordType());
5320 
5321   // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
5322   //   For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
5323   //   parameter is
5324   //
5325   //     - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
5326   //        ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
5327   //     - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
5328   //        ref-qualifier
5329   //
5330   // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
5331   // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
5332   //
5333   // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
5334   // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions
5335   // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
5336   // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
5337   // non-constant references.
5338 
5339   // First check the qualifiers.
5340   QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
5341   if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
5342                                     != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
5343       !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
5344     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
5345                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5346     return ICS;
5347   }
5348 
5349   if (FromTypeCanon.hasAddressSpace()) {
5350     Qualifiers QualsImplicitParamType = ImplicitParamType.getQualifiers();
5351     Qualifiers QualsFromType = FromTypeCanon.getQualifiers();
5352     if (!QualsImplicitParamType.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(QualsFromType)) {
5353       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
5354                  FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5355       return ICS;
5356     }
5357   }
5358 
5359   // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
5360   // affects the conversion rank.
5361   QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
5362   ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
5363   if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
5364     SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
5365   } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType))
5366     SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
5367   else {
5368     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
5369                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5370     return ICS;
5371   }
5372 
5373   // Check the ref-qualifier.
5374   switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
5375   case RQ_None:
5376     // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
5377     break;
5378 
5379   case RQ_LValue:
5380     if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && !Quals.hasOnlyConst()) {
5381       // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
5382       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
5383                  ImplicitParamType);
5384       return ICS;
5385     }
5386     break;
5387 
5388   case RQ_RValue:
5389     if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
5390       // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
5391       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
5392                  ImplicitParamType);
5393       return ICS;
5394     }
5395     break;
5396   }
5397 
5398   // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
5399   ICS.setStandard();
5400   ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5401   ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
5402   ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
5403   ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
5404   ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
5405   ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
5406   ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
5407   ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
5408   ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
5409   ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
5410     = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
5411   return ICS;
5412 }
5413 
5414 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
5415 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
5416 /// expression.
5417 ExprResult
5418 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
5419                                           NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
5420                                           NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
5421                                           CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
5422   QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
5423   QualType ImplicitParamRecordType  =
5424     Method->getThisType()->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5425 
5426   Expr::Classification FromClassification;
5427   if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5428     FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
5429     DestType = Method->getThisType();
5430     FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
5431   } else {
5432     FromRecordType = From->getType();
5433     DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
5434     FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
5435 
5436     // When performing member access on an rvalue, materialize a temporary.
5437     if (From->isRValue()) {
5438       From = CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(FromRecordType, From,
5439                                             Method->getRefQualifier() !=
5440                                                 RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue);
5441     }
5442   }
5443 
5444   // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
5445   // the actual argument initialization.
5446   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
5447       *this, From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method,
5448       Method->getParent());
5449   if (ICS.isBad()) {
5450     switch (ICS.Bad.Kind) {
5451     case BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers: {
5452       Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
5453       Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
5454       unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
5455       if (CVR) {
5456         Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
5457             << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
5458             << From->getSourceRange();
5459         Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
5460           << Method->getDeclName();
5461         return ExprError();
5462       }
5463       break;
5464     }
5465 
5466     case BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue:
5467     case BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue: {
5468       bool IsRValueQualified =
5469         Method->getRefQualifier() == RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue;
5470       Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_ref)
5471           << Method->getDeclName() << FromClassification.isRValue()
5472           << IsRValueQualified;
5473       Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
5474         << Method->getDeclName();
5475       return ExprError();
5476     }
5477 
5478     case BadConversionSequence::no_conversion:
5479     case BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class:
5480       break;
5481     }
5482 
5483     return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_type)
5484            << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType
5485            << From->getSourceRange();
5486   }
5487 
5488   if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
5489     ExprResult FromRes =
5490       PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
5491     if (FromRes.isInvalid())
5492       return ExprError();
5493     From = FromRes.get();
5494   }
5495 
5496   if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) {
5497     CastKind CK;
5498     QualType PteeTy = DestType->getPointeeType();
5499     LangAS DestAS =
5500         PteeTy.isNull() ? DestType.getAddressSpace() : PteeTy.getAddressSpace();
5501     if (FromRecordType.getAddressSpace() != DestAS)
5502       CK = CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
5503     else
5504       CK = CK_NoOp;
5505     From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK, From->getValueKind()).get();
5506   }
5507   return From;
5508 }
5509 
5510 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
5511 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
5512 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5513 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5514   // C++ [dcl.init]/17.8:
5515   //   - Otherwise, if the initialization is direct-initialization, the source
5516   //     type is std::nullptr_t, and the destination type is bool, the initial
5517   //     value of the object being initialized is false.
5518   if (From->getType()->isNullPtrType())
5519     return ImplicitConversionSequence::getNullptrToBool(From->getType(),
5520                                                         S.Context.BoolTy,
5521                                                         From->isGLValue());
5522 
5523   // All other direct-initialization of bool is equivalent to an implicit
5524   // conversion to bool in which explicit conversions are permitted.
5525   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
5526                                /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5527                                AllowedExplicit::Conversions,
5528                                /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5529                                /*CStyle=*/false,
5530                                /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5531                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5532 }
5533 
5534 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
5535 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
5536 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
5537   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5538     return ExprError();
5539 
5540   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
5541   if (!ICS.isBad())
5542     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
5543 
5544   if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
5545     return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
5546            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
5547   return ExprError();
5548 }
5549 
5550 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
5551 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
5552 /// is acceptable.
5553 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
5554                                               StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5555   // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
5556   // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
5557   // conversions are fine.
5558   switch (SCS.Second) {
5559   case ICK_Identity:
5560   case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
5561   case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere.
5562   case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion:
5563     return true;
5564 
5565   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
5566     // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
5567     // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral
5568     // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression.
5569     //
5570     // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks
5571     // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this
5572     // (non-conforming) extension.
5573     return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5574            SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
5575 
5576   case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
5577   case ICK_Pointer_Member:
5578     // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are
5579     // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t.
5580     return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType();
5581 
5582   case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
5583   case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
5584   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
5585   case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
5586   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
5587   case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
5588   case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
5589   case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
5590   case ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion:
5591   case ICK_Vector_Splat:
5592   case ICK_Complex_Real:
5593   case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
5594   case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
5595   case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
5596   case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
5597   case ICK_C_Only_Conversion:
5598   case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion:
5599     return false;
5600 
5601   case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
5602   case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
5603   case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
5604     llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second");
5605 
5606   case ICK_Function_Conversion:
5607   case ICK_Qualification:
5608     llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second");
5609 
5610   case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
5611     break;
5612   }
5613 
5614   llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
5615 }
5616 
5617 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
5618 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
5619 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
5620 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From,
5621                                                    QualType T, APValue &Value,
5622                                                    Sema::CCEKind CCE,
5623                                                    bool RequireInt,
5624                                                    NamedDecl *Dest) {
5625   assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 &&
5626          "converted constant expression outside C++11");
5627 
5628   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From))
5629     return ExprError();
5630 
5631   // C++1z [expr.const]p3:
5632   //  A converted constant expression of type T is an expression,
5633   //  implicitly converted to type T, where the converted
5634   //  expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion
5635   //  sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...].
5636   // C++1z [stmt.if]p2:
5637   //  If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the
5638   //  condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type
5639   //  bool.
5640   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5641       CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf || CCE == Sema::CCEK_ExplicitBool
5642           ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From)
5643           : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T,
5644                                   /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5645                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5646                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5647                                   /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
5648   StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr;
5649   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5650   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5651     SCS = &ICS.Standard;
5652     break;
5653   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5654     if (T->isRecordType())
5655       SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.Before;
5656     else
5657       SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
5658     break;
5659   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5660   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5661     if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
5662       return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5663                     diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
5664              << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5665     return ExprError();
5666 
5667   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5668     llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
5669   }
5670 
5671   // Check that we would only use permitted conversions.
5672   if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) {
5673     return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5674                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5675            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5676   }
5677   // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly.
5678   if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) {
5679     return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5680                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect)
5681            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5682   }
5683 
5684   // Usually we can simply apply the ImplicitConversionSequence we formed
5685   // earlier, but that's not guaranteed to work when initializing an object of
5686   // class type.
5687   ExprResult Result;
5688   if (T->isRecordType()) {
5689     assert(CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg &&
5690            "unexpected class type converted constant expr");
5691     Result = S.PerformCopyInitialization(
5692         InitializedEntity::InitializeTemplateParameter(
5693             T, cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Dest)),
5694         SourceLocation(), From);
5695   } else {
5696     Result = S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting);
5697   }
5698   if (Result.isInvalid())
5699     return Result;
5700 
5701   // C++2a [intro.execution]p5:
5702   //   A full-expression is [...] a constant-expression [...]
5703   Result =
5704       S.ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.get(), From->getExprLoc(),
5705                             /*DiscardedValue=*/false, /*IsConstexpr=*/true);
5706   if (Result.isInvalid())
5707     return Result;
5708 
5709   // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
5710   bool ReturnPreNarrowingValue = false;
5711   APValue PreNarrowingValue;
5712   QualType PreNarrowingType;
5713   switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
5714                                 PreNarrowingType)) {
5715   case NK_Dependent_Narrowing:
5716     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is
5717     // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing.
5718   case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
5719     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
5720     // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
5721   case NK_Not_Narrowing:
5722     break;
5723 
5724   case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
5725     if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_ArrayBound &&
5726         PreNarrowingType->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5727         PreNarrowingValue.isInt()) {
5728       // Don't diagnose array bound narrowing here; we produce more precise
5729       // errors by allowing the un-narrowed value through.
5730       ReturnPreNarrowingValue = true;
5731       break;
5732     }
5733     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5734         << CCE << /*Constant*/ 1
5735         << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
5736     break;
5737 
5738   case NK_Type_Narrowing:
5739     // FIXME: It would be better to diagnose that the expression is not a
5740     // constant expression.
5741     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5742         << CCE << /*Constant*/ 0 << From->getType() << T;
5743     break;
5744   }
5745 
5746   if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) {
5747     Value = APValue();
5748     return Result;
5749   }
5750 
5751   // Check the expression is a constant expression.
5752   SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
5753   Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5754   Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5755 
5756   ConstantExprKind Kind;
5757   if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg && T->isRecordType())
5758     Kind = ConstantExprKind::ClassTemplateArgument;
5759   else if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg)
5760     Kind = ConstantExprKind::NonClassTemplateArgument;
5761   else
5762     Kind = ConstantExprKind::Normal;
5763 
5764   if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(Eval, S.Context, Kind) ||
5765       (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) {
5766     // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5767     // the AST.
5768     Result = ExprError();
5769   } else {
5770     Value = Eval.Val;
5771 
5772     if (Notes.empty()) {
5773       // It's a constant expression.
5774       Expr *E = ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Result.get(), Value);
5775       if (ReturnPreNarrowingValue)
5776         Value = std::move(PreNarrowingValue);
5777       return E;
5778     }
5779   }
5780 
5781   // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5782   if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5783       Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
5784     S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5785   } else if (!Notes.empty() && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
5786                                    diag::note_constexpr_invalid_template_arg) {
5787     Notes[0].second.setDiagID(diag::err_constexpr_invalid_template_arg);
5788     for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5789       S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5790   } else {
5791     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
5792         << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5793     for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5794       S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5795   }
5796   return ExprError();
5797 }
5798 
5799 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5800                                                   APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE,
5801                                                   NamedDecl *Dest) {
5802   return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false,
5803                                             Dest);
5804 }
5805 
5806 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5807                                                   llvm::APSInt &Value,
5808                                                   CCEKind CCE) {
5809   assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
5810 
5811   APValue V;
5812   auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true,
5813                                               /*Dest=*/nullptr);
5814   if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent())
5815     Value = V.getInt();
5816   return R;
5817 }
5818 
5819 
5820 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5821 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them.  This may change
5822 /// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5823 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5824   if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5825     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5826     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5827     SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5828   }
5829 }
5830 
5831 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5832 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5833 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5834 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5835   // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5836   QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5837   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5838     = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5839                             // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5840                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5841                             AllowedExplicit::Conversions,
5842                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5843                             /*CStyle=*/false,
5844                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5845                             /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true);
5846 
5847   // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5848   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5849   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5850   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5851   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5852     break;
5853 
5854   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5855     dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5856     break;
5857 
5858   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5859     dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5860     break;
5861   }
5862 
5863   return ICS;
5864 }
5865 
5866 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5867 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5868 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists.
5869 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
5870   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5871     return ExprError();
5872 
5873   QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
5874   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5875     TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
5876   if (!ICS.isBad())
5877     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
5878   return ExprResult();
5879 }
5880 
5881 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5882 /// type of a permitted flavor.
5883 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) {
5884   return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5885                                  : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5886 }
5887 
5888 static ExprResult
5889 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5890                             Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5891                             QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) {
5892 
5893   if (Converter.Suppress)
5894     return ExprError();
5895 
5896   Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5897   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5898     CXXConversionDecl *Conv =
5899         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5900     QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5901     Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy);
5902   }
5903   return From;
5904 }
5905 
5906 static bool
5907 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5908                            Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5909                            QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5910                            UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) {
5911   if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) {
5912     DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5913     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5914         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5915 
5916     // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5917     // conversion; use it.
5918     QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5919     std::string TypeStr;
5920     ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy());
5921 
5922     Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5923         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getBeginLoc(),
5924                                       "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5925         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
5926                SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getEndLoc()), ")");
5927     Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy);
5928 
5929     // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
5930     // explicit conversion function.
5931     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5932       return true;
5933 
5934     SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5935     ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5936                                                        HadMultipleCandidates);
5937     if (Result.isInvalid())
5938       return true;
5939     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5940     From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5941                                     CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5942                                     nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(),
5943                                     SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides());
5944   }
5945   return false;
5946 }
5947 
5948 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5949                              Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5950                              QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5951                              DeclAccessPair &Found) {
5952   CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5953       cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5954   SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5955 
5956   QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5957   if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) {
5958     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5959       return true;
5960 
5961     Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType)
5962         << From->getSourceRange();
5963   }
5964 
5965   ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5966                                                      HadMultipleCandidates);
5967   if (Result.isInvalid())
5968     return true;
5969   // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5970   From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5971                                   CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5972                                   nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(),
5973                                   SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides());
5974   return false;
5975 }
5976 
5977 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion(
5978     Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5979     Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5980   if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress)
5981     Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType())
5982         << From->getSourceRange();
5983 
5984   return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5985 }
5986 
5987 static void
5988 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5989                                   UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions,
5990                                   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5991   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5992     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I];
5993     NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
5994     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
5995     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5996       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5997 
5998     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
5999     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
6000     if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
6001       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
6002     else
6003       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6004 
6005     if (ConvTemplate)
6006       SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
6007           ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet,
6008           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
6009     else
6010       SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From,
6011                                      ToType, CandidateSet,
6012                                      /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false,
6013                                      /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
6014   }
6015 }
6016 
6017 /// Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted
6018 /// by the given converter.
6019 ///
6020 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a
6021 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class
6022 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching
6023 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only
6024 /// one target type.
6025 ///
6026 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
6027 /// conversion.
6028 ///
6029 /// \param From The expression we're converting from.
6030 ///
6031 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process.
6032 ///
6033 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
6034 /// successful.
6035 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion(
6036     SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
6037   // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
6038   if (From->isTypeDependent())
6039     return From;
6040 
6041   // Process placeholders immediately.
6042   if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
6043     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
6044     if (result.isInvalid())
6045       return result;
6046     From = result.get();
6047   }
6048 
6049   // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden.
6050   QualType T = From->getType();
6051   if (Converter.match(T))
6052     return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
6053 
6054   // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
6055 
6056   // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class
6057   // type.
6058   const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
6059   if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6060     if (!Converter.Suppress)
6061       Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
6062     return From;
6063   }
6064 
6065   // We must have a complete class type.
6066   struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
6067     ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter;
6068     Expr *From;
6069 
6070     TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From)
6071         : Converter(Converter), From(From) {}
6072 
6073     void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
6074       Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
6075     }
6076   } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From);
6077 
6078   if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T)
6079                          : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
6080     return From;
6081 
6082   // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
6083   UnresolvedSet<4>
6084       ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y.
6085   UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
6086   const auto &Conversions =
6087       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6088 
6089   bool HadMultipleCandidates =
6090       (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1);
6091 
6092   // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y:
6093   QualType ToType;
6094   bool HasUniqueTargetType = true;
6095 
6096   // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions.
6097   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6098     NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
6099     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion;
6100     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
6101     if (ConvTemplate) {
6102       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14)
6103         Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
6104       else
6105         continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?).
6106     } else
6107       Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6108 
6109     assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) &&
6110            "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially "
6111            "viable in C++1y");
6112 
6113     QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6114     if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) {
6115 
6116       if (Conversion->isExplicit()) {
6117         // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction?
6118         // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion()
6119         if (!ConvTemplate)
6120           ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
6121       } else {
6122         if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
6123           if (ToType.isNull())
6124             ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType();
6125           else if (HasUniqueTargetType &&
6126                    (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType))
6127             HasUniqueTargetType = false;
6128         }
6129         ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
6130       }
6131     }
6132   }
6133 
6134   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
6135     // C++1y [conv]p6:
6136     // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context
6137     // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified
6138     // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly
6139     // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched
6140     // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to
6141     // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be
6142     // exactly one such T.
6143 
6144     // If no unique T is found:
6145     if (ToType.isNull()) {
6146       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6147                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6148                                      ExplicitConversions))
6149         return ExprError();
6150       return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
6151     }
6152 
6153     // If more than one unique Ts are found:
6154     if (!HasUniqueTargetType)
6155       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6156                                          ViableConversions);
6157 
6158     // If one unique T is found:
6159     // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded
6160     // potentially viable conversions.
6161     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
6162     collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions,
6163                                       CandidateSet);
6164 
6165     // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set.
6166     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
6167     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) {
6168     case OR_Success: {
6169       // Apply this conversion.
6170       DeclAccessPair Found =
6171           DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
6172       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6173                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
6174         return ExprError();
6175       break;
6176     }
6177     case OR_Ambiguous:
6178       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6179                                          ViableConversions);
6180     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
6181       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6182                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6183                                      ExplicitConversions))
6184         return ExprError();
6185       LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
6186     case OR_Deleted:
6187       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
6188       break;
6189     }
6190   } else {
6191     switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
6192     case 0: {
6193       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6194                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6195                                      ExplicitConversions))
6196         return ExprError();
6197 
6198       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
6199       break;
6200     }
6201     case 1: {
6202       // Apply this conversion.
6203       DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
6204       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6205                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
6206         return ExprError();
6207       break;
6208     }
6209     default:
6210       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6211                                          ViableConversions);
6212     }
6213   }
6214 
6215   return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
6216 }
6217 
6218 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is
6219 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose
6220 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine
6221 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning
6222 /// enumeration types.
6223 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context,
6224                                                    FunctionDecl *Fn,
6225                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
6226   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
6227   QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType();
6228 
6229   if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType()))
6230     return true;
6231 
6232   if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType()))
6233     return true;
6234 
6235   const auto *Proto = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6236   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1)
6237     return false;
6238 
6239   if (T1->isEnumeralType()) {
6240     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType();
6241     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType))
6242       return true;
6243   }
6244 
6245   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2)
6246     return false;
6247 
6248   if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) {
6249     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType();
6250     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType))
6251       return true;
6252   }
6253 
6254   return false;
6255 }
6256 
6257 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
6258 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments.  If
6259 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
6260 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
6261 ///
6262 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
6263 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
6264 /// code completion.
6265 void Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(
6266     FunctionDecl *Function, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6267     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
6268     bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6269     ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions,
6270     OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6271   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
6272     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
6273   assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
6274   assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
6275          "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
6276 
6277   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
6278     if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
6279       // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
6280       // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
6281       // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
6282       // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
6283       // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
6284       // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
6285       // is irrelevant.
6286       AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(),
6287                          Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args,
6288                          CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6289                          PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions, PO);
6290       return;
6291     }
6292     // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
6293     // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
6294   }
6295 
6296   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function, PO))
6297     return;
6298 
6299   // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402]
6300   //   A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by
6301   //   overload resolution.
6302   CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function);
6303   if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() &&
6304       Constructor->isMoveConstructor())
6305     return;
6306 
6307   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6308   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
6309       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
6310 
6311   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6312   //   if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the
6313   //   lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to
6314   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there
6315   //   is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to
6316   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are
6317   //   candidate functions.
6318   if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
6319       !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args))
6320     return;
6321 
6322   // Add this candidate
6323   OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
6324       CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions);
6325   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6326   Candidate.Function = Function;
6327   Candidate.Viable = true;
6328   Candidate.RewriteKind =
6329       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Function, PO);
6330   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6331   Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate;
6332   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6333   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6334 
6335   // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not
6336   // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point
6337   // to them in diagnostics.
6338   if (!AllowExplicit && ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Function).isExplicit()) {
6339     Candidate.Viable = false;
6340     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
6341     return;
6342   }
6343 
6344   if (Function->isMultiVersion() && Function->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
6345       !Function->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
6346     Candidate.Viable = false;
6347     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
6348     return;
6349   }
6350 
6351   if (Constructor) {
6352     // C++ [class.copy]p3:
6353     //   A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
6354     //   of a class object to an object of its class type.
6355     QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
6356     if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
6357         (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
6358          IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getBeginLoc(), Args[0]->getType(),
6359                        ClassType))) {
6360       Candidate.Viable = false;
6361       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor;
6362       return;
6363     }
6364 
6365     // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution)
6366     //   A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter
6367     //   of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated
6368     //   from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when
6369     //   constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly
6370     //   one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related
6371     //   to C.
6372     auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl());
6373     if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 &&
6374         Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
6375       QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType();
6376       QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent());
6377       QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent());
6378       SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc();
6379       if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) &&
6380           (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) {
6381         Candidate.Viable = false;
6382         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice;
6383         return;
6384       }
6385     }
6386 
6387     // Check that the constructor is capable of constructing an object in the
6388     // destination address space.
6389     if (!Qualifiers::isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(
6390             Constructor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace(),
6391             CandidateSet.getDestAS())) {
6392       Candidate.Viable = false;
6393       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch;
6394     }
6395   }
6396 
6397   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6398 
6399   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6400   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6401   // list (8.3.5).
6402   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
6403       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6404     Candidate.Viable = false;
6405     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6406     return;
6407   }
6408 
6409   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
6410   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
6411   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
6412   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
6413   // exactly m parameters.
6414   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
6415   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
6416     // Not enough arguments.
6417     Candidate.Viable = false;
6418     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6419     return;
6420   }
6421 
6422   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
6423   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
6424     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
6425       // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this
6426       // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is
6427       // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of
6428       // the class.
6429       if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) {
6430         Candidate.Viable = false;
6431         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
6432         return;
6433       }
6434 
6435   if (Function->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
6436     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
6437     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Function, Satisfaction) ||
6438         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
6439       Candidate.Viable = false;
6440       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
6441       return;
6442     }
6443   }
6444 
6445   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6446   // arguments.
6447   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
6448     unsigned ConvIdx =
6449         PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 - ArgIdx : ArgIdx;
6450     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
6451       // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during
6452       // template argument deduction.
6453     } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6454       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6455       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6456       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6457       // parameter of F.
6458       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6459       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization(
6460           *this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, SuppressUserConversions,
6461           /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6462           /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6463           getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, AllowExplicitConversions);
6464       if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6465         Candidate.Viable = false;
6466         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6467         return;
6468       }
6469     } else {
6470       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6471       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6472       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6473       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
6474     }
6475   }
6476 
6477   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
6478           CheckEnableIf(Function, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args)) {
6479     Candidate.Viable = false;
6480     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6481     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6482     return;
6483   }
6484 
6485   if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) {
6486     Candidate.Viable = false;
6487     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled;
6488     return;
6489   }
6490 }
6491 
6492 ObjCMethodDecl *
6493 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance,
6494                        SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) {
6495   if (Methods.size() <= 1)
6496     return nullptr;
6497 
6498   for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
6499     bool Match = true;
6500     ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b];
6501     unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs();
6502     // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due
6503     // to addition of c-style arguments in method.
6504     if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs)
6505       NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size();
6506     if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs)
6507       continue;
6508 
6509     for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) {
6510       // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument.
6511       if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
6512         Match = false;
6513         break;
6514       }
6515 
6516       ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i];
6517       Expr *argExpr = Args[i];
6518       assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression");
6519 
6520       // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's
6521       // a consumed argument.
6522       if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) &&
6523           !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())
6524         argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr);
6525 
6526       // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method.
6527       if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
6528         Match = false;
6529         break;
6530       }
6531 
6532       ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState
6533         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(),
6534                                 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false,
6535                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6536                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6537                                 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
6538                                 /*AllowExplicit*/false);
6539       // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider
6540       // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here.
6541       if (ConversionState.isBad() ||
6542           (ConversionState.isStandard() &&
6543            ConversionState.Standard.Second ==
6544                ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) {
6545         Match = false;
6546         break;
6547       }
6548     }
6549     // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods.
6550     if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) {
6551       for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) {
6552         if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
6553           Match = false;
6554           break;
6555         }
6556         ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
6557                                                           nullptr);
6558         if (Arg.isInvalid()) {
6559           Match = false;
6560           break;
6561         }
6562       }
6563     } else {
6564       // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods.
6565       if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs)
6566         Match = false;
6567       else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) {
6568         // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select
6569         // one with the most general result type of 'id'.
6570         for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
6571           QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType();
6572           if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType())
6573             return Methods[b];
6574         }
6575       }
6576     }
6577 
6578     if (Match)
6579       return Method;
6580   }
6581   return nullptr;
6582 }
6583 
6584 static bool convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(
6585     Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg, SourceLocation CallLoc,
6586     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap, bool MissingImplicitThis,
6587     Expr *&ConvertedThis, SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) {
6588   if (ThisArg) {
6589     CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function);
6590     assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
6591            "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!");
6592     assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!");
6593     ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(
6594         ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method);
6595     if (R.isInvalid())
6596       return false;
6597     ConvertedThis = R.get();
6598   } else {
6599     if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
6600       (void)MD;
6601       assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() ||
6602               isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) &&
6603              "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods");
6604     }
6605     ConvertedThis = nullptr;
6606   }
6607 
6608   // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the
6609   // user can't refer to them in the function condition.
6610   unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size());
6611 
6612   // Convert the arguments.
6613   for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) {
6614     ExprResult R;
6615     R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
6616                                         S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)),
6617                                     SourceLocation(), Args[I]);
6618 
6619     if (R.isInvalid())
6620       return false;
6621 
6622     ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
6623   }
6624 
6625   if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
6626     return false;
6627 
6628   // Push default arguments if needed.
6629   if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) {
6630     for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
6631       ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i);
6632       if (!P->hasDefaultArg())
6633         return false;
6634       ExprResult R = S.BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, Function, P);
6635       if (R.isInvalid())
6636         return false;
6637       ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
6638     }
6639 
6640     if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
6641       return false;
6642   }
6643   return true;
6644 }
6645 
6646 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function,
6647                                   SourceLocation CallLoc,
6648                                   ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6649                                   bool MissingImplicitThis) {
6650   auto EnableIfAttrs = Function->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
6651   if (EnableIfAttrs.begin() == EnableIfAttrs.end())
6652     return nullptr;
6653 
6654   SFINAETrap Trap(*this);
6655   SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs;
6656   // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed.
6657   Expr *DiscardedThis;
6658   if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(
6659           *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, CallLoc, Args, Trap,
6660           /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs))
6661     return *EnableIfAttrs.begin();
6662 
6663   for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) {
6664     APValue Result;
6665     // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is
6666     // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully.
6667     if (EIA->getCond()->isValueDependent() ||
6668         !EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
6669             Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs)))
6670       return EIA;
6671 
6672     if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue())
6673       return EIA;
6674   }
6675   return nullptr;
6676 }
6677 
6678 template <typename CheckFn>
6679 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND,
6680                                         bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc,
6681                                         CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) {
6682   SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs;
6683   for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) {
6684     if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent())
6685       Attrs.push_back(DIA);
6686   }
6687 
6688   // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early.
6689   if (Attrs.empty())
6690     return false;
6691 
6692   auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition(
6693       Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(),
6694       [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); });
6695 
6696   // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the
6697   // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes).
6698   auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin),
6699                                IsSuccessful);
6700   if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) {
6701     const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr;
6702     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage();
6703     S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if)
6704         << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange();
6705     return true;
6706   }
6707 
6708   for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end()))
6709     if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) {
6710       S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage();
6711       S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if)
6712           << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange();
6713     }
6714 
6715   return false;
6716 }
6717 
6718 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function,
6719                                                const Expr *ThisArg,
6720                                                ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args,
6721                                                SourceLocation Loc) {
6722   return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(
6723       *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc,
6724       [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) {
6725         APValue Result;
6726         // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since
6727         // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each
6728         // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to.
6729         if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
6730                 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg))
6731           return false;
6732         return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue();
6733       });
6734 }
6735 
6736 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND,
6737                                                  SourceLocation Loc) {
6738   return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(
6739       *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc,
6740       [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) {
6741         bool Result;
6742         return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) &&
6743                Result;
6744       });
6745 }
6746 
6747 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
6748 /// the overload candidate set.
6749 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
6750                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6751                                  OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6752                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6753                                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
6754                                  bool PartialOverloading,
6755                                  bool FirstArgumentIsBase) {
6756   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
6757     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
6758     ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args;
6759 
6760     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
6761     FunctionDecl *FD =
6762         FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
6763 
6764     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) {
6765       QualType ObjectType;
6766       Expr::Classification ObjectClassification;
6767       if (Args.size() > 0) {
6768         if (Expr *E = Args[0]) {
6769           // Use the explicit base to restrict the lookup:
6770           ObjectType = E->getType();
6771           // Pointers in the object arguments are implicitly dereferenced, so we
6772           // always classify them as l-values.
6773           if (!ObjectType.isNull() && ObjectType->isPointerType())
6774             ObjectClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
6775           else
6776             ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context);
6777         } // .. else there is an implicit base.
6778         FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1);
6779       }
6780       if (FunTmpl) {
6781         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
6782             FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
6783             cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
6784             ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6785             FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6786             PartialOverloading);
6787       } else {
6788         AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
6789                            cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType,
6790                            ObjectClassification, FunctionArgs, CandidateSet,
6791                            SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6792       }
6793     } else {
6794       // This branch handles both standalone functions and static methods.
6795 
6796       // Slice the first argument (which is the base) when we access
6797       // static method as non-static.
6798       if (Args.size() > 0 &&
6799           (!Args[0] || (FirstArgumentIsBase && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) &&
6800                         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)))) {
6801         assert(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic());
6802         FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1);
6803       }
6804       if (FunTmpl) {
6805         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
6806                                      ExplicitTemplateArgs, FunctionArgs,
6807                                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6808                                      PartialOverloading);
6809       } else {
6810         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet,
6811                              SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6812       }
6813     }
6814   }
6815 }
6816 
6817 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
6818 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
6819 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, QualType ObjectType,
6820                               Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6821                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6822                               OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6823                               bool SuppressUserConversions,
6824                               OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6825   NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
6826   CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
6827 
6828   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
6829     Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
6830 
6831   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
6832     assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
6833            "Expected a member function template");
6834     AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6835                                /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType,
6836                                ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
6837                                SuppressUserConversions, false, PO);
6838   } else {
6839     AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6840                        ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
6841                        SuppressUserConversions, false, None, PO);
6842   }
6843 }
6844 
6845 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
6846 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
6847 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
6848 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
6849 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
6850 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
6851 /// operators.
6852 void
6853 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6854                          CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
6855                          Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6856                          ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6857                          OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6858                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
6859                          bool PartialOverloading,
6860                          ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions,
6861                          OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6862   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
6863     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
6864   assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
6865   assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
6866          "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
6867 
6868   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method, PO))
6869     return;
6870 
6871   // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402]
6872   //   A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is
6873   //   ignored by overload resolution.
6874   if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() &&
6875       Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
6876     return;
6877 
6878   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6879   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
6880       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
6881 
6882   // Add this candidate
6883   OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
6884       CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions);
6885   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6886   Candidate.Function = Method;
6887   Candidate.RewriteKind =
6888       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Method, PO);
6889   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6890   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6891   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6892 
6893   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6894 
6895   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6896   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6897   // list (8.3.5).
6898   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
6899       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6900     Candidate.Viable = false;
6901     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6902     return;
6903   }
6904 
6905   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
6906   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
6907   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
6908   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
6909   // exactly m parameters.
6910   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
6911   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
6912     // Not enough arguments.
6913     Candidate.Viable = false;
6914     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6915     return;
6916   }
6917 
6918   Candidate.Viable = true;
6919 
6920   if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
6921     // The implicit object argument is ignored.
6922     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
6923   else {
6924     unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0;
6925     // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
6926     // parameter.
6927     Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
6928         *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6929         Method, ActingContext);
6930     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6931       Candidate.Viable = false;
6932       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6933       return;
6934     }
6935   }
6936 
6937   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
6938   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
6939     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
6940       if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) {
6941         Candidate.Viable = false;
6942         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
6943         return;
6944       }
6945 
6946   if (Method->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
6947     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
6948     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Method, Satisfaction) ||
6949         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
6950       Candidate.Viable = false;
6951       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
6952       return;
6953     }
6954   }
6955 
6956   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6957   // arguments.
6958   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
6959     unsigned ConvIdx =
6960         PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 0 : (ArgIdx + 1);
6961     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
6962       // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during
6963       // template argument deduction.
6964     } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6965       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6966       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6967       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6968       // parameter of F.
6969       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6970       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx]
6971         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
6972                                 SuppressUserConversions,
6973                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6974                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6975                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
6976       if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6977         Candidate.Viable = false;
6978         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6979         return;
6980       }
6981     } else {
6982       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6983       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6984       // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6985       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
6986     }
6987   }
6988 
6989   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
6990           CheckEnableIf(Method, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args, true)) {
6991     Candidate.Viable = false;
6992     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6993     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6994     return;
6995   }
6996 
6997   if (Method->isMultiVersion() && Method->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
6998       !Method->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
6999     Candidate.Viable = false;
7000     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
7001   }
7002 }
7003 
7004 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
7005 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
7006 /// function template specialization.
7007 void Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
7008     FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7009     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
7010     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ObjectType,
7011     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7012     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7013     bool PartialOverloading, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7014   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl, PO))
7015     return;
7016 
7017   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
7018   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
7019   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
7020   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
7021   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
7022   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
7023   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
7024   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
7025   //   functions.
7026   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7027   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7028   ConversionSequenceList Conversions;
7029   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments(
7030           MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info,
7031           PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) {
7032             return CheckNonDependentConversions(
7033                 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions,
7034                 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType,
7035                 ObjectClassification, PO);
7036           })) {
7037     OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
7038         CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions);
7039     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7040     Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
7041     Candidate.Viable = false;
7042     Candidate.RewriteKind =
7043       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO);
7044     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7045     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument =
7046         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() ||
7047         ObjectType.isNull();
7048     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7049     if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure)
7050       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7051     else {
7052       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7053       Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7054                                                             Info);
7055     }
7056     return;
7057   }
7058 
7059   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
7060   // deduction as a candidate.
7061   assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
7062   assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
7063          "Specialization is not a member function?");
7064   AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
7065                      ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
7066                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading,
7067                      Conversions, PO);
7068 }
7069 
7070 /// Determine whether a given function template has a simple explicit specifier
7071 /// or a non-value-dependent explicit-specification that evaluates to true.
7072 static bool isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD) {
7073   return ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(FTD->getTemplatedDecl()).isExplicit();
7074 }
7075 
7076 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
7077 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
7078 /// an appropriate function template specialization.
7079 void Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
7080     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7081     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7082     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7083     bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate,
7084     OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7085   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate, PO))
7086     return;
7087 
7088   // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification,
7089   // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction
7090   // and substitution in this case.
7091   if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) {
7092     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7093     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7094     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7095     Candidate.Viable = false;
7096     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7097     return;
7098   }
7099 
7100   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
7101   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
7102   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
7103   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
7104   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
7105   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
7106   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
7107   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
7108   //   functions.
7109   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7110   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7111   ConversionSequenceList Conversions;
7112   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments(
7113           FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info,
7114           PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) {
7115             return CheckNonDependentConversions(
7116                 FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions,
7117                 SuppressUserConversions, nullptr, QualType(), {}, PO);
7118           })) {
7119     OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
7120         CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions);
7121     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7122     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7123     Candidate.Viable = false;
7124     Candidate.RewriteKind =
7125       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO);
7126     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7127     Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate;
7128     // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object
7129     // type.
7130     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument =
7131         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) &&
7132         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function);
7133     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7134     if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure)
7135       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7136     else {
7137       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7138       Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7139                                                             Info);
7140     }
7141     return;
7142   }
7143 
7144   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
7145   // deduction as a candidate.
7146   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
7147   AddOverloadCandidate(
7148       Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
7149       PartialOverloading, AllowExplicit,
7150       /*AllowExplicitConversions*/ false, IsADLCandidate, Conversions, PO);
7151 }
7152 
7153 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument
7154 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's
7155 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10.
7156 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions(
7157     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes,
7158     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7159     ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7160     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
7161     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7162   // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor
7163   // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear
7164   // that is correct.
7165   const bool AllowExplicit = false;
7166 
7167   auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7168   auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
7169   bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method);
7170   unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0;
7171 
7172   Conversions =
7173       CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size());
7174 
7175   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7176   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7177       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7178 
7179   // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't
7180   // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and
7181   // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations.
7182   if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() &&
7183       !ObjectType.isNull()) {
7184     unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0;
7185     Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7186         *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
7187         Method, ActingContext);
7188     if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
7189       return true;
7190   }
7191 
7192   for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N;
7193        ++I) {
7194     QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I];
7195     if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) {
7196       unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed
7197                              ? 0
7198                              : (ThisConversions + I);
7199       Conversions[ConvIdx]
7200         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType,
7201                                 SuppressUserConversions,
7202                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
7203                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7204                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
7205                                 AllowExplicit);
7206       if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
7207         return true;
7208     }
7209   }
7210 
7211   return false;
7212 }
7213 
7214 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result
7215 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++
7216 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1.
7217 ///
7218 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function.
7219 ///
7220 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to.
7221 ///
7222 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one
7223 /// Objective-C pointer to another.
7224 ///
7225 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise.
7226 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S,
7227                                           QualType ConvType, QualType ToType,
7228                                           bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) {
7229   QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
7230 
7231   // Easy case: the types are the same.
7232   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType))
7233     return true;
7234 
7235   // Allow qualification conversions.
7236   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
7237   if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false,
7238                                   ObjCLifetimeConversion))
7239     return true;
7240 
7241   // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions,
7242   // we're done.
7243   if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion)
7244     return false;
7245 
7246   // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion?
7247   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
7248   QualType ConvertedType;
7249   return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType,
7250                                    IncompatibleObjC);
7251 }
7252 
7253 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
7254 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
7255 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
7256 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
7257 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
7258 /// conversion function produces).
7259 void Sema::AddConversionCandidate(
7260     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7261     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
7262     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7263     bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) {
7264   assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
7265          "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
7266   QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7267   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
7268     return;
7269 
7270   // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its
7271   // deduction now.
7272   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) {
7273     if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc()))
7274       return;
7275     ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7276   }
7277 
7278   // If we don't allow any conversion of the result type, ignore conversion
7279   // functions that don't convert to exactly (possibly cv-qualified) T.
7280   if (!AllowResultConversion &&
7281       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Conversion->getConversionType(), ToType))
7282     return;
7283 
7284   // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion
7285   // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or
7286   // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion.
7287   //
7288   // FIXME: Include such functions in the candidate list and explain why we
7289   // can't select them.
7290   if (Conversion->isExplicit() &&
7291       !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType,
7292                                      AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit))
7293     return;
7294 
7295   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7296   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7297       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7298 
7299   // Add this candidate
7300   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
7301   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7302   Candidate.Function = Conversion;
7303   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7304   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7305   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
7306   Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
7307   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
7308   Candidate.Viable = true;
7309   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
7310 
7311   // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not
7312   // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point
7313   // to them in diagnostics.
7314   if (!AllowExplicit && Conversion->isExplicit()) {
7315     Candidate.Viable = false;
7316     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7317     return;
7318   }
7319 
7320   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
7321   //   For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
7322   //   the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
7323   //   defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
7324   //
7325   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
7326   // object parameter.
7327   QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
7328   if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
7329     ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
7330   CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
7331     = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
7332 
7333   Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7334       *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(),
7335       From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext);
7336 
7337   if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
7338     Candidate.Viable = false;
7339     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7340     return;
7341   }
7342 
7343   if (Conversion->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
7344     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
7345     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Conversion, Satisfaction) ||
7346         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
7347       Candidate.Viable = false;
7348       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
7349       return;
7350     }
7351   }
7352 
7353   // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a
7354   // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
7355   // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
7356   QualType FromCanon
7357     = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
7358   QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
7359   if (FromCanon == ToCanon ||
7360       IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
7361     Candidate.Viable = false;
7362     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
7363     return;
7364   }
7365 
7366   // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
7367   // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
7368   // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
7369   // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
7370   // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
7371   // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
7372   // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
7373   // well-formed.
7374   DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Context, Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
7375                             VK_LValue, From->getBeginLoc());
7376   ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
7377                                 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
7378                                 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, &ConversionRef,
7379                                 VK_RValue, FPOptionsOverride());
7380 
7381   QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
7382   if (!isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ConversionType)) {
7383     Candidate.Viable = false;
7384     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7385     return;
7386   }
7387 
7388   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
7389 
7390   // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
7391   // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
7392   // allocator).
7393   QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7394 
7395   alignas(CallExpr) char Buffer[sizeof(CallExpr) + sizeof(Stmt *)];
7396   CallExpr *TheTemporaryCall = CallExpr::CreateTemporary(
7397       Buffer, &ConversionFn, CallResultType, VK, From->getBeginLoc());
7398 
7399   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
7400       TryCopyInitialization(*this, TheTemporaryCall, ToType,
7401                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
7402                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7403                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
7404 
7405   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
7406   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
7407     Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
7408 
7409     // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
7410     //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
7411     //   conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
7412     //   shall have exact match rank.
7413     if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
7414         GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
7415       Candidate.Viable = false;
7416       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
7417       return;
7418     }
7419 
7420     // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
7421     //    In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
7422     //    the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
7423     //    conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
7424     //    program is ill-formed.
7425     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
7426         ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
7427       Candidate.Viable = false;
7428       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7429       return;
7430     }
7431     break;
7432 
7433   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
7434     Candidate.Viable = false;
7435     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7436     return;
7437 
7438   default:
7439     llvm_unreachable(
7440            "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
7441   }
7442 
7443   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
7444           CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) {
7445     Candidate.Viable = false;
7446     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
7447     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
7448     return;
7449   }
7450 
7451   if (Conversion->isMultiVersion() && Conversion->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
7452       !Conversion->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
7453     Candidate.Viable = false;
7454     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
7455   }
7456 }
7457 
7458 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization
7459 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
7460 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
7461 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
7462 /// [temp.deduct.conv]).
7463 void Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
7464     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7465     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
7466     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7467     bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) {
7468   assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
7469          "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
7470 
7471   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
7472     return;
7473 
7474   // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification,
7475   // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction
7476   // and substitution in this case.
7477   if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) {
7478     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7479     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7480     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7481     Candidate.Viable = false;
7482     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7483     return;
7484   }
7485 
7486   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7487   CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7488   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
7489         = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
7490                                   Specialization, Info)) {
7491     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7492     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7493     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7494     Candidate.Viable = false;
7495     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7496     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7497     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7498     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
7499     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7500                                                           Info);
7501     return;
7502   }
7503 
7504   // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
7505   // template argument deduction as a candidate.
7506   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
7507   AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
7508                          CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7509                          AllowExplicit, AllowResultConversion);
7510 }
7511 
7512 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
7513 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
7514 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
7515 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
7516 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
7517 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
7518                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7519                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
7520                                  const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
7521                                  Expr *Object,
7522                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7523                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
7524   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
7525     return;
7526 
7527   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7528   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7529       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7530 
7531   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
7532   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7533   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
7534   Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
7535   Candidate.Viable = true;
7536   Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
7537   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7538   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7539 
7540   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
7541   // object parameter.
7542   ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7543       *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(),
7544       Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext);
7545   if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
7546     Candidate.Viable = false;
7547     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7548     Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
7549     return;
7550   }
7551 
7552   // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
7553   // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
7554   // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
7555   Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
7556   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
7557   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
7558   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
7559   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
7560   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
7561   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
7562     = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
7563   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
7564 
7565   // Find the
7566   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
7567 
7568   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
7569   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
7570   // list (8.3.5).
7571   if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
7572     Candidate.Viable = false;
7573     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
7574     return;
7575   }
7576 
7577   // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
7578   // we have enough arguments.
7579   if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
7580     // Not enough arguments.
7581     Candidate.Viable = false;
7582     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
7583     return;
7584   }
7585 
7586   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
7587   // arguments.
7588   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7589     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
7590       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
7591       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
7592       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
7593       // parameter of F.
7594       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
7595       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
7596         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
7597                                 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
7598                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7599                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7600                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7601       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
7602         Candidate.Viable = false;
7603         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7604         return;
7605       }
7606     } else {
7607       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
7608       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
7609       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
7610       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
7611     }
7612   }
7613 
7614   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
7615           CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) {
7616     Candidate.Viable = false;
7617     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
7618     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
7619     return;
7620   }
7621 }
7622 
7623 /// Add all of the non-member operator function declarations in the given
7624 /// function set to the overload candidate set.
7625 void Sema::AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(
7626     const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7627     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7628     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
7629   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
7630     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
7631     ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args;
7632 
7633     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
7634     FunctionDecl *FD =
7635         FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
7636 
7637     // Don't consider rewritten functions if we're not rewriting.
7638     if (!CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isAcceptableCandidate(FD))
7639       continue;
7640 
7641     assert(!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) &&
7642            "unqualified operator lookup found a member function");
7643 
7644     if (FunTmpl) {
7645       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7646                                    FunctionArgs, CandidateSet);
7647       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD))
7648         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
7649             FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7650             {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, false, false,
7651             true, ADLCallKind::NotADL, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
7652     } else {
7653       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
7654         continue;
7655       AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet);
7656       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD))
7657         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(),
7658                              {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet,
7659                              false, false, true, false, ADLCallKind::NotADL,
7660                              None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
7661     }
7662   }
7663 }
7664 
7665 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
7666 /// member functions.
7667 ///
7668 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
7669 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
7670 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
7671 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
7672 /// [over.match.oper]).
7673 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7674                                        SourceLocation OpLoc,
7675                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7676                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7677                                        OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7678   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
7679 
7680   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7681   //   For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
7682   //   cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
7683   //   a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
7684   //   a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
7685   //   three sets of candidate functions, designated member
7686   //   candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
7687   //   constructed as follows:
7688   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
7689 
7690   //     -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
7691   //        defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
7692   //        qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
7693   //        the set of member candidates is empty.
7694   if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7695     // Complete the type if it can be completed.
7696     if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined())
7697       return;
7698     // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
7699     if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
7700       return;
7701 
7702     LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
7703     LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
7704     Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
7705 
7706     for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
7707                              OperEnd = Operators.end();
7708          Oper != OperEnd;
7709          ++Oper)
7710       AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
7711                          Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
7712                          CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false, PO);
7713   }
7714 }
7715 
7716 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
7717 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
7718 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
7719 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
7720 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
7721 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
7722 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
7723 /// converted to bool.
7724 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7725                                OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
7726                                bool IsAssignmentOperator,
7727                                unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
7728   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7729   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7730       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7731 
7732   // Add this candidate
7733   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
7734   Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none);
7735   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
7736   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7737   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7738   std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes);
7739 
7740   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
7741   // arguments.
7742   Candidate.Viable = true;
7743   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7744   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7745     // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
7746     //   For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
7747     //   left operand are restricted as follows:
7748     //     -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
7749     //     -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
7750     //        operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
7751     //        parameter of a built-in candidate.
7752     //
7753     // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
7754     // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
7755     // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
7756     // is not of the same type.
7757     if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
7758       assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
7759              "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
7760       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
7761         = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
7762     } else {
7763       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
7764         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
7765                                 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
7766                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7767                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7768                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7769     }
7770     if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
7771       Candidate.Viable = false;
7772       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7773       break;
7774     }
7775   }
7776 }
7777 
7778 namespace {
7779 
7780 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
7781 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
7782 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
7783 /// enumeration types.
7784 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet  {
7785   /// TypeSet - A set of types.
7786   typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>,
7787                           llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet;
7788 
7789   /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
7790   /// built-in candidates.
7791   TypeSet PointerTypes;
7792 
7793   /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
7794   /// used in the built-in candidates.
7795   TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
7796 
7797   /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
7798   /// used in the built-in candidates.
7799   TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
7800 
7801   /// The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
7802   /// candidates.
7803   TypeSet VectorTypes;
7804 
7805   /// The set of matrix types that will be used in the built-in
7806   /// candidates.
7807   TypeSet MatrixTypes;
7808 
7809   /// A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
7810   bool HasNonRecordTypes;
7811 
7812   /// A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
7813   /// were present in the candidate set.
7814   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
7815 
7816   /// A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
7817   /// candidate set.
7818   bool HasNullPtrType;
7819 
7820   /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
7821   /// candidate type set.
7822   Sema &SemaRef;
7823 
7824   /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
7825   ASTContext &Context;
7826 
7827   bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
7828                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
7829   bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
7830 
7831 public:
7832   /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
7833   typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
7834 
7835   BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
7836     : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
7837       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
7838       HasNullPtrType(false),
7839       SemaRef(SemaRef),
7840       Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
7841 
7842   void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
7843                              SourceLocation Loc,
7844                              bool AllowUserConversions,
7845                              bool AllowExplicitConversions,
7846                              const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
7847 
7848   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> pointer_types() { return PointerTypes; }
7849   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> member_pointer_types() {
7850     return MemberPointerTypes;
7851   }
7852   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> enumeration_types() {
7853     return EnumerationTypes;
7854   }
7855   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> vector_types() { return VectorTypes; }
7856   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> matrix_types() { return MatrixTypes; }
7857 
7858   bool containsMatrixType(QualType Ty) const { return MatrixTypes.count(Ty); }
7859   bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
7860   bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
7861   bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
7862 };
7863 
7864 } // end anonymous namespace
7865 
7866 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
7867 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
7868 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
7869 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
7870 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
7871 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
7872 /// false otherwise.
7873 ///
7874 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
7875 bool
7876 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
7877                                              const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
7878 
7879   // Insert this type.
7880   if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
7881     return false;
7882 
7883   QualType PointeeTy;
7884   const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
7885   bool buildObjCPtr = false;
7886   if (!PointerTy) {
7887     const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7888     PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
7889     buildObjCPtr = true;
7890   } else {
7891     PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
7892   }
7893 
7894   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
7895   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
7896   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
7897   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
7898   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
7899     return true;
7900 
7901   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
7902   bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
7903   bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
7904 
7905   // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
7906   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
7907     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
7908     // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
7909     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
7910 
7911     // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
7912     // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
7913     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
7914         (!hasRestrict ||
7915          (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
7916       continue;
7917 
7918     // Build qualified pointee type.
7919     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
7920 
7921     // Build qualified pointer type.
7922     QualType QPointerTy;
7923     if (!buildObjCPtr)
7924       QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
7925     else
7926       QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
7927 
7928     // Insert qualified pointer type.
7929     PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
7930   }
7931 
7932   return true;
7933 }
7934 
7935 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
7936 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
7937 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
7938 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
7939 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
7940 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
7941 /// false otherwise.
7942 ///
7943 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
7944 bool
7945 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
7946     QualType Ty) {
7947   // Insert this type.
7948   if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
7949     return false;
7950 
7951   const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
7952   assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
7953 
7954   QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
7955   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
7956   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
7957   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
7958   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
7959   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
7960     return true;
7961   const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
7962 
7963   // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
7964   // qualifiers.
7965   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
7966   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
7967     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
7968 
7969     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
7970     MemberPointerTypes.insert(
7971       Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
7972   }
7973 
7974   return true;
7975 }
7976 
7977 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
7978 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
7979 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
7980 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
7981 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
7982 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
7983 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
7984 /// type.
7985 void
7986 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
7987                                                SourceLocation Loc,
7988                                                bool AllowUserConversions,
7989                                                bool AllowExplicitConversions,
7990                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
7991   // Only deal with canonical types.
7992   Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
7993 
7994   // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
7995   // expression for the purposes of conversions.
7996   if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7997     Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
7998 
7999   // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
8000   if (Ty->isArrayType())
8001     Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
8002 
8003   // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
8004   Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
8005 
8006   // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
8007   const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
8008   HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
8009 
8010   // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
8011   HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
8012     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
8013 
8014   if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
8015     PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
8016   else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8017     // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
8018     // of types.
8019     if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
8020       return;
8021   } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
8022     // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
8023     if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
8024       return;
8025   } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
8026     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8027     EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
8028   } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
8029     // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
8030     // extension.
8031     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8032     VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
8033   } else if (Ty->isMatrixType()) {
8034     // Similar to vector types, we treat vector types as arithmetic types in
8035     // many contexts as an extension.
8036     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8037     MatrixTypes.insert(Ty);
8038   } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
8039     HasNullPtrType = true;
8040   } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
8041     // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
8042     if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty))
8043       return;
8044 
8045     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
8046     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
8047       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8048         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
8049 
8050       // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
8051       // about which builtin types we can convert to.
8052       if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
8053         continue;
8054 
8055       CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
8056       if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
8057         AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
8058                               VisibleQuals);
8059       }
8060     }
8061   }
8062 }
8063 /// Helper function for adjusting address spaces for the pointer or reference
8064 /// operands of builtin operators depending on the argument.
8065 static QualType AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
8066                                                         Expr *Arg) {
8067   return S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(T, Arg->getType().getAddressSpace());
8068 }
8069 
8070 /// Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
8071 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
8072 /// given type to the candidate set.
8073 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
8074                                                    QualType T,
8075                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8076                                     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
8077   QualType ParamTypes[2];
8078 
8079   // T& operator=(T&, T)
8080   ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8081       AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, T, Args[0]));
8082   ParamTypes[1] = T;
8083   S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8084                         /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8085 
8086   if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
8087     // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
8088     ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8089         AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, S.Context.getVolatileType(T),
8090                                                 Args[0]));
8091     ParamTypes[1] = T;
8092     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8093                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8094   }
8095 }
8096 
8097 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
8098 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
8099 static  Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
8100     Qualifiers VRQuals;
8101     const RecordType *TyRec;
8102     if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
8103         ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8104       TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
8105     else
8106       TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
8107     if (!TyRec) {
8108       // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
8109       VRQuals.addVolatile();
8110       VRQuals.addRestrict();
8111       return VRQuals;
8112     }
8113 
8114     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
8115     if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
8116       return VRQuals;
8117 
8118     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
8119       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8120         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
8121       if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
8122         QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
8123         if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8124           CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8125         // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
8126         // as see them.
8127         bool done = false;
8128         while (!done) {
8129           if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
8130             VRQuals.addRestrict();
8131           if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8132             CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8133           else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
8134                 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8135             CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
8136           else
8137             done = true;
8138           if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
8139             VRQuals.addVolatile();
8140           if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
8141             return VRQuals;
8142         }
8143       }
8144     }
8145     return VRQuals;
8146 }
8147 
8148 namespace {
8149 
8150 /// Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
8151 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
8152 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
8153 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
8154 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
8155   // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
8156   Sema &S;
8157   ArrayRef<Expr *> Args;
8158   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
8159   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
8160   SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
8161   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
8162 
8163   static constexpr int ArithmeticTypesCap = 24;
8164   SmallVector<CanQualType, ArithmeticTypesCap> ArithmeticTypes;
8165 
8166   // Define some indices used to iterate over the arithmetic types in
8167   // ArithmeticTypes.  The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
8168   // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
8169   unsigned FirstIntegralType,
8170            LastIntegralType;
8171   unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType,
8172            LastPromotedIntegralType;
8173   unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType,
8174            LastPromotedArithmeticType;
8175   unsigned NumArithmeticTypes;
8176 
8177   void InitArithmeticTypes() {
8178     // Start of promoted types.
8179     FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0;
8180     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.FloatTy);
8181     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.DoubleTy);
8182     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongDoubleTy);
8183     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type())
8184       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Float128Ty);
8185 
8186     // Start of integral types.
8187     FirstIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8188     FirstPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8189     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.IntTy);
8190     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongTy);
8191     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongLongTy);
8192     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() ||
8193         (S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo() &&
8194          S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo()->hasInt128Type()))
8195       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Int128Ty);
8196     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedIntTy);
8197     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongTy);
8198     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy);
8199     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() ||
8200         (S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo() &&
8201          S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo()->hasInt128Type()))
8202       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty);
8203     LastPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8204     LastPromotedArithmeticType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8205     // End of promoted types.
8206 
8207     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.BoolTy);
8208     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.CharTy);
8209     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.WCharTy);
8210     if (S.Context.getLangOpts().Char8)
8211       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char8Ty);
8212     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char16Ty);
8213     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char32Ty);
8214     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.SignedCharTy);
8215     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.ShortTy);
8216     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedCharTy);
8217     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedShortTy);
8218     LastIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8219     NumArithmeticTypes = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8220     // End of integral types.
8221     // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
8222 
8223     assert(ArithmeticTypes.size() <= ArithmeticTypesCap &&
8224            "Enough inline storage for all arithmetic types.");
8225   }
8226 
8227   /// Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
8228   /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
8229   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
8230                                            bool HasVolatile,
8231                                            bool HasRestrict) {
8232     QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8233       S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
8234       S.Context.IntTy
8235     };
8236 
8237     // Non-volatile version.
8238     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8239 
8240     // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
8241     // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
8242     if (HasVolatile) {
8243       ParamTypes[0] =
8244         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8245           S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
8246       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8247     }
8248 
8249     // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
8250     // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
8251     if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
8252         !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
8253       ParamTypes[0]
8254         = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8255             S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
8256       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8257 
8258       if (HasVolatile) {
8259         ParamTypes[0]
8260           = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8261               S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
8262                                             (Qualifiers::Volatile |
8263                                              Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8264         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8265       }
8266     }
8267 
8268   }
8269 
8270   /// Helper to add an overload candidate for a binary builtin with types \p L
8271   /// and \p R.
8272   void AddCandidate(QualType L, QualType R) {
8273     QualType LandR[2] = {L, R};
8274     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8275   }
8276 
8277 public:
8278   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
8279     Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8280     Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
8281     bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
8282     SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
8283     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
8284     : S(S), Args(Args),
8285       VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
8286       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
8287         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
8288       CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
8289       CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
8290 
8291     InitArithmeticTypes();
8292   }
8293 
8294   // Increment is deprecated for bool since C++17.
8295   //
8296   // C++ [over.built]p3:
8297   //
8298   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
8299   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
8300   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8301   //
8302   //       VQ T&      operator++(VQ T&);
8303   //       T          operator++(VQ T&, int);
8304   //
8305   // C++ [over.built]p4:
8306   //
8307   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
8308   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
8309   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8310   //
8311   //       VQ T&      operator--(VQ T&);
8312   //       T          operator--(VQ T&, int);
8313   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8314     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8315       return;
8316 
8317     for (unsigned Arith = 0; Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
8318       const auto TypeOfT = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
8319       if (TypeOfT == S.Context.BoolTy) {
8320         if (Op == OO_MinusMinus)
8321           continue;
8322         if (Op == OO_PlusPlus && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17)
8323           continue;
8324       }
8325       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
8326         TypeOfT,
8327         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
8328         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
8329     }
8330   }
8331 
8332   // C++ [over.built]p5:
8333   //
8334   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
8335   //   cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
8336   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8337   //
8338   //       T*VQ&      operator++(T*VQ&);
8339   //       T*VQ&      operator--(T*VQ&);
8340   //       T*         operator++(T*VQ&, int);
8341   //       T*         operator--(T*VQ&, int);
8342   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
8343     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
8344       // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
8345       if (!PtrTy->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
8346         continue;
8347 
8348       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
8349           PtrTy,
8350           (!PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() &&
8351            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
8352           (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() &&
8353            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
8354     }
8355   }
8356 
8357   // C++ [over.built]p6:
8358   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
8359   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8360   //
8361   //       T&         operator*(T*);
8362   //
8363   // C++ [over.built]p7:
8364   //   For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
8365   //   ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8366   //       T&         operator*(T*);
8367   void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
8368     for (QualType ParamTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
8369       QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
8370       if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
8371         continue;
8372 
8373       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
8374         if (Proto->getMethodQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
8375           continue;
8376 
8377       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8378     }
8379   }
8380 
8381   // C++ [over.built]p9:
8382   //  For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
8383   //  operator functions of the form
8384   //
8385   //       T         operator+(T);
8386   //       T         operator-(T);
8387   void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
8388     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8389       return;
8390 
8391     for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8392          Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
8393       QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
8394       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8395     }
8396 
8397     // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
8398     for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8399       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8400   }
8401 
8402   // C++ [over.built]p8:
8403   //   For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
8404   //   the form
8405   //
8406   //       T*         operator+(T*);
8407   void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
8408     for (QualType ParamTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types())
8409       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8410   }
8411 
8412   // C++ [over.built]p10:
8413   //   For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
8414   //   operator functions of the form
8415   //
8416   //        T         operator~(T);
8417   void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
8418     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8419       return;
8420 
8421     for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8422          Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
8423       QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int];
8424       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8425     }
8426 
8427     // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
8428     for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8429       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8430   }
8431 
8432   // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
8433   //   For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there
8434   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8435   //
8436   //        bool operator==(T,T);
8437   //        bool operator!=(T,T);
8438   void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() {
8439     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8440     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8441 
8442     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8443       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) {
8444         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
8445         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second)
8446           continue;
8447 
8448         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {MemPtrTy, MemPtrTy};
8449         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8450       }
8451 
8452       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
8453         CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
8454         if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) {
8455           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
8456           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8457         }
8458       }
8459     }
8460   }
8461 
8462   // C++ [over.built]p15:
8463   //
8464   //   For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type,
8465   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8466   //
8467   //        bool       operator<(T, T);
8468   //        bool       operator>(T, T);
8469   //        bool       operator<=(T, T);
8470   //        bool       operator>=(T, T);
8471   //        bool       operator==(T, T);
8472   //        bool       operator!=(T, T);
8473   //           R       operator<=>(T, T)
8474   void addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
8475     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8476     //   [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
8477     //   functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
8478     //   do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
8479     //   candidate.
8480     //
8481     // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
8482     // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
8483     // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
8484     // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
8485     // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
8486     // where we must suppress candidates like this.
8487     llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
8488       UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
8489 
8490     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8491       if (!CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types().empty()) {
8492         for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
8493                                          CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
8494              C != CEnd; ++C) {
8495           if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
8496             continue;
8497 
8498           if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
8499             continue;
8500 
8501           // We interpret "same parameter-type-list" as applying to the
8502           // "synthesized candidate, with the order of the two parameters
8503           // reversed", not to the original function.
8504           bool Reversed = C->isReversed();
8505           QualType FirstParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 1 : 0)
8506                                         ->getType()
8507                                         .getUnqualifiedType();
8508           QualType SecondParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 0 : 1)
8509                                          ->getType()
8510                                          .getUnqualifiedType();
8511 
8512           // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
8513           if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
8514               !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
8515             continue;
8516 
8517           // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
8518           UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
8519             std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
8520                            S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
8521         }
8522       }
8523     }
8524 
8525     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8526     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8527 
8528     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8529       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_types()) {
8530         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
8531         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
8532           continue;
8533 
8534         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy};
8535         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8536       }
8537       for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) {
8538         CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy);
8539 
8540         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
8541         // candidate exists.
8542         if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second ||
8543             UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
8544                                                             CanonType)))
8545           continue;
8546         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {EnumTy, EnumTy};
8547         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8548       }
8549     }
8550   }
8551 
8552   // C++ [over.built]p13:
8553   //
8554   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
8555   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8556   //
8557   //      T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
8558   //      T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);    [BELOW]
8559   //      T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
8560   //      T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
8561   //      T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);    [BELOW]
8562   //
8563   // C++ [over.built]p14:
8564   //
8565   //   For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
8566   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8567   //
8568   //      ptrdiff_t  operator-(T, T);
8569   void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8570     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8571     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8572 
8573     for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
8574       QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = {
8575         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8576         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8577       };
8578       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_types()) {
8579         QualType PointeeTy = PtrTy->getPointeeType();
8580         if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
8581           continue;
8582 
8583         AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = PtrTy;
8584         if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
8585           // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
8586           // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
8587           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8588         }
8589         if (Op == OO_Minus) {
8590           // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
8591           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
8592             continue;
8593 
8594           QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy};
8595           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8596         }
8597       }
8598     }
8599   }
8600 
8601   // C++ [over.built]p12:
8602   //
8603   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
8604   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8605   //
8606   //        LR         operator*(L, R);
8607   //        LR         operator/(L, R);
8608   //        LR         operator+(L, R);
8609   //        LR         operator-(L, R);
8610   //        bool       operator<(L, R);
8611   //        bool       operator>(L, R);
8612   //        bool       operator<=(L, R);
8613   //        bool       operator>=(L, R);
8614   //        bool       operator==(L, R);
8615   //        bool       operator!=(L, R);
8616   //
8617   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8618   //   between types L and R.
8619   //
8620   // C++ [over.built]p24:
8621   //
8622   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
8623   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8624   //
8625   //        LR       operator?(bool, L, R);
8626   //
8627   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8628   //   between types L and R.
8629   // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
8630   void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() {
8631     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8632       return;
8633 
8634     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8635          Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
8636       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8637            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
8638         QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left],
8639                               ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
8640         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8641       }
8642     }
8643 
8644     // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
8645     // conditional operator for vector types.
8646     for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8647       for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[1].vector_types()) {
8648         QualType LandR[2] = {Vec1Ty, Vec2Ty};
8649         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8650       }
8651   }
8652 
8653   /// Add binary operator overloads for each candidate matrix type M1, M2:
8654   ///  * (M1, M1) -> M1
8655   ///  * (M1, M1.getElementType()) -> M1
8656   ///  * (M2.getElementType(), M2) -> M2
8657   ///  * (M2, M2) -> M2 // Only if M2 is not part of CandidateTypes[0].
8658   void addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads() {
8659     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8660       return;
8661 
8662     for (QualType M1 : CandidateTypes[0].matrix_types()) {
8663       AddCandidate(M1, cast<MatrixType>(M1)->getElementType());
8664       AddCandidate(M1, M1);
8665     }
8666 
8667     for (QualType M2 : CandidateTypes[1].matrix_types()) {
8668       AddCandidate(cast<MatrixType>(M2)->getElementType(), M2);
8669       if (!CandidateTypes[0].containsMatrixType(M2))
8670         AddCandidate(M2, M2);
8671     }
8672   }
8673 
8674   // C++2a [over.built]p14:
8675   //
8676   //   For every integral type T there exists a candidate operator function
8677   //   of the form
8678   //
8679   //        std::strong_ordering operator<=>(T, T)
8680   //
8681   // C++2a [over.built]p15:
8682   //
8683   //   For every pair of floating-point types L and R, there exists a candidate
8684   //   operator function of the form
8685   //
8686   //       std::partial_ordering operator<=>(L, R);
8687   //
8688   // FIXME: The current specification for integral types doesn't play nice with
8689   // the direction of p0946r0, which allows mixed integral and unscoped-enum
8690   // comparisons. Under the current spec this can lead to ambiguity during
8691   // overload resolution. For example:
8692   //
8693   //   enum A : int {a};
8694   //   auto x = (a <=> (long)42);
8695   //
8696   //   error: call is ambiguous for arguments 'A' and 'long'.
8697   //   note: candidate operator<=>(int, int)
8698   //   note: candidate operator<=>(long, long)
8699   //
8700   // To avoid this error, this function deviates from the specification and adds
8701   // the mixed overloads `operator<=>(L, R)` where L and R are promoted
8702   // arithmetic types (the same as the generic relational overloads).
8703   //
8704   // For now this function acts as a placeholder.
8705   void addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads() {
8706     addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
8707   }
8708 
8709   // C++ [over.built]p17:
8710   //
8711   //   For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
8712   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8713   //
8714   //      LR         operator%(L, R);
8715   //      LR         operator&(L, R);
8716   //      LR         operator^(L, R);
8717   //      LR         operator|(L, R);
8718   //      L          operator<<(L, R);
8719   //      L          operator>>(L, R);
8720   //
8721   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8722   //   between types L and R.
8723   void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8724     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8725       return;
8726 
8727     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8728          Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
8729       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8730            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
8731         QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left],
8732                               ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
8733         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8734       }
8735     }
8736   }
8737 
8738   // C++ [over.built]p20:
8739   //
8740   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
8741   //   pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
8742   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8743   //
8744   //        VQ T&      operator=(VQ T&, T);
8745   void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
8746     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8747     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8748 
8749     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
8750       for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) {
8751         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy)).second)
8752           continue;
8753 
8754         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, EnumTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8755       }
8756 
8757       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) {
8758         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second)
8759           continue;
8760 
8761         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, MemPtrTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8762       }
8763     }
8764   }
8765 
8766   // C++ [over.built]p19:
8767   //
8768   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
8769   //   volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
8770   //   of the form
8771   //
8772   //        T*VQ&      operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
8773   //
8774   // C++ [over.built]p21:
8775   //
8776   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
8777   //   cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
8778   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8779   //
8780   //        T*VQ&      operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
8781   //        T*VQ&      operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
8782   void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
8783     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8784     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8785 
8786     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
8787       // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
8788       if (isEqualOp)
8789         AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy));
8790       else if (!PtrTy->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
8791         continue;
8792 
8793       // non-volatile version
8794       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8795           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PtrTy),
8796           isEqualOp ? PtrTy : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8797       };
8798       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8799                             /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
8800 
8801       bool NeedVolatile = !PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() &&
8802                           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
8803       if (NeedVolatile) {
8804         // volatile version
8805         ParamTypes[0] =
8806             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(PtrTy));
8807         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8808                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8809       }
8810 
8811       if (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() &&
8812           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
8813         // restrict version
8814         ParamTypes[0] =
8815             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(PtrTy));
8816         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8817                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8818 
8819         if (NeedVolatile) {
8820           // volatile restrict version
8821           ParamTypes[0] =
8822               S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(
8823                   PtrTy, (Qualifiers::Volatile | Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8824           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8825                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8826         }
8827       }
8828     }
8829 
8830     if (isEqualOp) {
8831       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].pointer_types()) {
8832         // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
8833         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
8834           continue;
8835 
8836         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8837             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PtrTy),
8838             PtrTy,
8839         };
8840 
8841         // non-volatile version
8842         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8843                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8844 
8845         bool NeedVolatile = !PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() &&
8846                             VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
8847         if (NeedVolatile) {
8848           // volatile version
8849           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8850               S.Context.getVolatileType(PtrTy));
8851           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8852                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8853         }
8854 
8855         if (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() &&
8856             VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
8857           // restrict version
8858           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8859               S.Context.getRestrictType(PtrTy));
8860           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8861                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8862 
8863           if (NeedVolatile) {
8864             // volatile restrict version
8865             ParamTypes[0] =
8866                 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(
8867                     PtrTy, (Qualifiers::Volatile | Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8868             S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8869                                   /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8870           }
8871         }
8872       }
8873     }
8874   }
8875 
8876   // C++ [over.built]p18:
8877   //
8878   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
8879   //   VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
8880   //   arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
8881   //   the form
8882   //
8883   //        VQ L&      operator=(VQ L&, R);
8884   //        VQ L&      operator*=(VQ L&, R);
8885   //        VQ L&      operator/=(VQ L&, R);
8886   //        VQ L&      operator+=(VQ L&, R);
8887   //        VQ L&      operator-=(VQ L&, R);
8888   void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
8889     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8890       return;
8891 
8892     for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
8893       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8894            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
8895         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8896         ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
8897         auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(
8898             S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]);
8899         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8900         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy);
8901         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8902                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8903 
8904         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8905         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8906           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(LeftBaseTy);
8907           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8908           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8909                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8910         }
8911       }
8912     }
8913 
8914     // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
8915     for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8916       for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) {
8917         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8918         ParamTypes[1] = Vec2Ty;
8919         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8920         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(Vec1Ty);
8921         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8922                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8923 
8924         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8925         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8926           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(Vec1Ty);
8927           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8928           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8929                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8930         }
8931       }
8932   }
8933 
8934   // C++ [over.built]p22:
8935   //
8936   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
8937   //   is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
8938   //   type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8939   //
8940   //        VQ L&       operator%=(VQ L&, R);
8941   //        VQ L&       operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
8942   //        VQ L&       operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
8943   //        VQ L&       operator&=(VQ L&, R);
8944   //        VQ L&       operator^=(VQ L&, R);
8945   //        VQ L&       operator|=(VQ L&, R);
8946   void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
8947     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8948       return;
8949 
8950     for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
8951       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8952            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
8953         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8954         ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
8955         auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(
8956             S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]);
8957         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8958         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy);
8959         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8960         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8961           // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8962           ParamTypes[0] = LeftBaseTy;
8963           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
8964           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8965           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8966         }
8967       }
8968     }
8969   }
8970 
8971   // C++ [over.operator]p23:
8972   //
8973   //   There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
8974   //
8975   //        bool        operator!(bool);
8976   //        bool        operator&&(bool, bool);
8977   //        bool        operator||(bool, bool);
8978   void addExclaimOverload() {
8979     QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
8980     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet,
8981                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
8982                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
8983   }
8984   void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
8985     QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
8986     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8987                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
8988                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
8989   }
8990 
8991   // C++ [over.built]p13:
8992   //
8993   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
8994   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8995   //
8996   //        T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
8997   //        T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
8998   //        T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
8999   //        T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);     [ABOVE]
9000   //        T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
9001   void addSubscriptOverloads() {
9002     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
9003       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, S.Context.getPointerDiffType()};
9004       QualType PointeeType = PtrTy->getPointeeType();
9005       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
9006         continue;
9007 
9008       // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
9009       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9010     }
9011 
9012     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].pointer_types()) {
9013       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), PtrTy};
9014       QualType PointeeType = PtrTy->getPointeeType();
9015       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
9016         continue;
9017 
9018       // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
9019       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9020     }
9021   }
9022 
9023   // C++ [over.built]p11:
9024   //    For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
9025   //    C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
9026   //    type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
9027   //    there exist candidate operator functions of the form
9028   //
9029   //      CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
9030   //
9031   //    where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
9032   void addArrowStarOverloads() {
9033     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
9034       QualType C1Ty = PtrTy;
9035       QualType C1;
9036       QualifierCollector Q1;
9037       C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
9038       if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
9039         continue;
9040       // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
9041       // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
9042       // volatile/restrict type.
9043       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
9044         continue;
9045       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
9046         continue;
9047       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_types()) {
9048         const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(MemPtrTy);
9049         QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
9050         C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
9051         if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2))
9052           break;
9053         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, MemPtrTy};
9054         // build CV12 T&
9055         QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
9056         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
9057             T.isVolatileQualified())
9058           continue;
9059         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
9060             T.isRestrictQualified())
9061           continue;
9062         T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
9063         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9064       }
9065     }
9066   }
9067 
9068   // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
9069   // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
9070   // therefore added as binary.
9071   //
9072   // C++ [over.built]p25:
9073   //   For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
9074   //   enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
9075   //
9076   //        T        operator?(bool, T, T);
9077   //
9078   void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
9079     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
9080     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
9081 
9082     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
9083       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_types()) {
9084         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
9085           continue;
9086 
9087         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy};
9088         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9089       }
9090 
9091       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) {
9092         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second)
9093           continue;
9094 
9095         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {MemPtrTy, MemPtrTy};
9096         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9097       }
9098 
9099       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
9100         for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) {
9101           if (!EnumTy->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
9102             continue;
9103 
9104           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy)).second)
9105             continue;
9106 
9107           QualType ParamTypes[2] = {EnumTy, EnumTy};
9108           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9109         }
9110       }
9111     }
9112   }
9113 };
9114 
9115 } // end anonymous namespace
9116 
9117 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
9118 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
9119 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
9120 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
9121 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
9122 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9123                                         SourceLocation OpLoc,
9124                                         ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
9125                                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
9126   // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
9127   // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
9128   // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
9129   // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
9130   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
9131   VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
9132   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
9133     VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
9134 
9135   bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
9136   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
9137   SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
9138   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
9139     CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this);
9140     CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
9141                                                  OpLoc,
9142                                                  true,
9143                                                  (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
9144                                                   Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
9145                                                   Op == OO_PipePipe),
9146                                                  VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
9147     HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
9148         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
9149     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
9150         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
9151         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
9152   }
9153 
9154   // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
9155   // for any of the arguments to the operator.
9156   //
9157   // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
9158   // 'bool' overloads.
9159   if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
9160       !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
9161     return;
9162 
9163   // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
9164   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args,
9165                                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
9166                                            HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
9167                                            CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
9168 
9169   // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
9170   switch (Op) {
9171   case OO_None:
9172   case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
9173     llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
9174 
9175   case OO_New:
9176   case OO_Delete:
9177   case OO_Array_New:
9178   case OO_Array_Delete:
9179   case OO_Call:
9180     llvm_unreachable(
9181                     "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
9182 
9183   case OO_Comma:
9184   case OO_Arrow:
9185   case OO_Coawait:
9186     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
9187     //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the
9188     //      operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the
9189     //      built-in candidates set is empty.
9190     break;
9191 
9192   case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
9193     if (Args.size() == 1)
9194       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
9195     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9196 
9197   case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
9198     if (Args.size() == 1) {
9199       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
9200     } else {
9201       OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
9202       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9203       OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9204     }
9205     break;
9206 
9207   case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
9208     if (Args.size() == 1)
9209       OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
9210     else {
9211       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9212       OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9213     }
9214     break;
9215 
9216   case OO_Slash:
9217     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9218     break;
9219 
9220   case OO_PlusPlus:
9221   case OO_MinusMinus:
9222     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9223     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
9224     break;
9225 
9226   case OO_EqualEqual:
9227   case OO_ExclaimEqual:
9228     OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads();
9229     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9230 
9231   case OO_Less:
9232   case OO_Greater:
9233   case OO_LessEqual:
9234   case OO_GreaterEqual:
9235     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9236     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9237     break;
9238 
9239   case OO_Spaceship:
9240     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9241     OpBuilder.addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads();
9242     break;
9243 
9244   case OO_Percent:
9245   case OO_Caret:
9246   case OO_Pipe:
9247   case OO_LessLess:
9248   case OO_GreaterGreater:
9249     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9250     break;
9251 
9252   case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
9253     if (Args.size() == 1)
9254       // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
9255       //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
9256       //      operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
9257       break;
9258 
9259     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9260     break;
9261 
9262   case OO_Tilde:
9263     OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
9264     break;
9265 
9266   case OO_Equal:
9267     OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9268     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9269 
9270   case OO_PlusEqual:
9271   case OO_MinusEqual:
9272     OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
9273     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9274 
9275   case OO_StarEqual:
9276   case OO_SlashEqual:
9277     OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
9278     break;
9279 
9280   case OO_PercentEqual:
9281   case OO_LessLessEqual:
9282   case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
9283   case OO_AmpEqual:
9284   case OO_CaretEqual:
9285   case OO_PipeEqual:
9286     OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
9287     break;
9288 
9289   case OO_Exclaim:
9290     OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
9291     break;
9292 
9293   case OO_AmpAmp:
9294   case OO_PipePipe:
9295     OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
9296     break;
9297 
9298   case OO_Subscript:
9299     OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
9300     break;
9301 
9302   case OO_ArrowStar:
9303     OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
9304     break;
9305 
9306   case OO_Conditional:
9307     OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
9308     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9309     break;
9310   }
9311 }
9312 
9313 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
9314 /// to the set of overloading candidates.
9315 ///
9316 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
9317 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
9318 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
9319 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
9320 void
9321 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
9322                                            SourceLocation Loc,
9323                                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
9324                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9325                                            OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
9326                                            bool PartialOverloading) {
9327   ADLResult Fns;
9328 
9329   // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
9330   // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
9331   // which means we need to key off the canonical decl.  However,
9332   // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
9333   // right set of default arguments.  What default arguments are
9334   // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
9335 
9336   // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
9337   ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns);
9338 
9339   // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
9340   for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
9341                                    CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
9342        Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
9343     if (Cand->Function) {
9344       Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
9345       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
9346         Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
9347     }
9348 
9349   // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
9350   // set.
9351   for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9352     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
9353 
9354     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
9355       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
9356         continue;
9357 
9358       AddOverloadCandidate(
9359           FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
9360           PartialOverloading, /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
9361           /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, ADLCallKind::UsesADL);
9362       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) {
9363         AddOverloadCandidate(
9364             FD, FoundDecl, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet,
9365             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9366             /*AllowExplicit=*/true, /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false,
9367             ADLCallKind::UsesADL, None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
9368       }
9369     } else {
9370       auto *FTD = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I);
9371       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
9372           FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet,
9373           /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9374           /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL);
9375       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(
9376               Context, FTD->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9377         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
9378             FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, {Args[1], Args[0]},
9379             CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9380             /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL,
9381             OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
9382       }
9383     }
9384   }
9385 }
9386 
9387 namespace {
9388 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse };
9389 }
9390 
9391 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of
9392 /// overload resolution.
9393 ///
9394 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff
9395 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as
9396 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if
9397 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes.
9398 ///
9399 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if
9400 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are
9401 /// worse than Cand1's.
9402 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1,
9403                                        const FunctionDecl *Cand2) {
9404   // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs.
9405   bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
9406   bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
9407   if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) {
9408     if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr)
9409       return Comparison::Equal;
9410     return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse;
9411   }
9412 
9413   auto Cand1Attrs = Cand1->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
9414   auto Cand2Attrs = Cand2->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
9415 
9416   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID;
9417   for (auto Pair : zip_longest(Cand1Attrs, Cand2Attrs)) {
9418     Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand1A = std::get<0>(Pair);
9419     Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand2A = std::get<1>(Pair);
9420 
9421     // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1
9422     // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2, and vice versa.
9423     if (!Cand1A)
9424       return Comparison::Worse;
9425     if (!Cand2A)
9426       return Comparison::Better;
9427 
9428     Cand1ID.clear();
9429     Cand2ID.clear();
9430 
9431     (*Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
9432     (*Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
9433     if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID)
9434       return Comparison::Worse;
9435   }
9436 
9437   return Comparison::Equal;
9438 }
9439 
9440 static Comparison
9441 isBetterMultiversionCandidate(const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
9442                               const OverloadCandidate &Cand2) {
9443   if (!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->isMultiVersion() || !Cand2.Function ||
9444       !Cand2.Function->isMultiVersion())
9445     return Comparison::Equal;
9446 
9447   // If both are invalid, they are equal. If one of them is invalid, the other
9448   // is better.
9449   if (Cand1.Function->isInvalidDecl()) {
9450     if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl())
9451       return Comparison::Equal;
9452     return Comparison::Worse;
9453   }
9454   if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl())
9455     return Comparison::Better;
9456 
9457   // If this is a cpu_dispatch/cpu_specific multiversion situation, prefer
9458   // cpu_dispatch, else arbitrarily based on the identifiers.
9459   bool Cand1CPUDisp = Cand1.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
9460   bool Cand2CPUDisp = Cand2.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
9461   const auto *Cand1CPUSpec = Cand1.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
9462   const auto *Cand2CPUSpec = Cand2.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
9463 
9464   if (!Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUSpec && !Cand2CPUSpec)
9465     return Comparison::Equal;
9466 
9467   if (Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp)
9468     return Comparison::Better;
9469   if (Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUDisp)
9470     return Comparison::Worse;
9471 
9472   if (Cand1CPUSpec && Cand2CPUSpec) {
9473     if (Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() != Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size())
9474       return Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() < Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size()
9475                  ? Comparison::Better
9476                  : Comparison::Worse;
9477 
9478     std::pair<CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator, CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator>
9479         FirstDiff = std::mismatch(
9480             Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end(),
9481             Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_begin(),
9482             [](const IdentifierInfo *LHS, const IdentifierInfo *RHS) {
9483               return LHS->getName() == RHS->getName();
9484             });
9485 
9486     assert(FirstDiff.first != Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end() &&
9487            "Two different cpu-specific versions should not have the same "
9488            "identifier list, otherwise they'd be the same decl!");
9489     return (*FirstDiff.first)->getName() < (*FirstDiff.second)->getName()
9490                ? Comparison::Better
9491                : Comparison::Worse;
9492   }
9493   llvm_unreachable("No way to get here unless both had cpu_dispatch");
9494 }
9495 
9496 /// Compute the type of the implicit object parameter for the given function,
9497 /// if any. Returns None if there is no implicit object parameter, and a null
9498 /// QualType if there is a 'matches anything' implicit object parameter.
9499 static Optional<QualType> getImplicitObjectParamType(ASTContext &Context,
9500                                                      const FunctionDecl *F) {
9501   if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(F) || isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(F))
9502     return llvm::None;
9503 
9504   auto *M = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(F);
9505   // Static member functions' object parameters match all types.
9506   if (M->isStatic())
9507     return QualType();
9508 
9509   QualType T = M->getThisObjectType();
9510   if (M->getRefQualifier() == RQ_RValue)
9511     return Context.getRValueReferenceType(T);
9512   return Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
9513 }
9514 
9515 static bool haveSameParameterTypes(ASTContext &Context, const FunctionDecl *F1,
9516                                    const FunctionDecl *F2, unsigned NumParams) {
9517   if (declaresSameEntity(F1, F2))
9518     return true;
9519 
9520   auto NextParam = [&](const FunctionDecl *F, unsigned &I, bool First) {
9521     if (First) {
9522       if (Optional<QualType> T = getImplicitObjectParamType(Context, F))
9523         return *T;
9524     }
9525     assert(I < F->getNumParams());
9526     return F->getParamDecl(I++)->getType();
9527   };
9528 
9529   unsigned I1 = 0, I2 = 0;
9530   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumParams; ++I) {
9531     QualType T1 = NextParam(F1, I1, I == 0);
9532     QualType T2 = NextParam(F2, I2, I == 0);
9533     if (!T1.isNull() && !T1.isNull() && !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
9534       return false;
9535   }
9536   return true;
9537 }
9538 
9539 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
9540 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
9541 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate(
9542     Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
9543     SourceLocation Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind Kind) {
9544   // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
9545   // functions.
9546   if (!Cand2.Viable)
9547     return Cand1.Viable;
9548   else if (!Cand1.Viable)
9549     return false;
9550 
9551   // [CUDA] A function with 'never' preference is marked not viable, therefore
9552   // is never shown up here. The worst preference shown up here is 'wrong side',
9553   // e.g. an H function called by a HD function in device compilation. This is
9554   // valid AST as long as the HD function is not emitted, e.g. it is an inline
9555   // function which is called only by an H function. A deferred diagnostic will
9556   // be triggered if it is emitted. However a wrong-sided function is still
9557   // a viable candidate here.
9558   //
9559   // If Cand1 can be emitted and Cand2 cannot be emitted in the current
9560   // context, Cand1 is better than Cand2. If Cand1 can not be emitted and Cand2
9561   // can be emitted, Cand1 is not better than Cand2. This rule should have
9562   // precedence over other rules.
9563   //
9564   // If both Cand1 and Cand2 can be emitted, or neither can be emitted, then
9565   // other rules should be used to determine which is better. This is because
9566   // host/device based overloading resolution is mostly for determining
9567   // viability of a function. If two functions are both viable, other factors
9568   // should take precedence in preference, e.g. the standard-defined preferences
9569   // like argument conversion ranks or enable_if partial-ordering. The
9570   // preference for pass-object-size parameters is probably most similar to a
9571   // type-based-overloading decision and so should take priority.
9572   //
9573   // If other rules cannot determine which is better, CUDA preference will be
9574   // used again to determine which is better.
9575   //
9576   // TODO: Currently IdentifyCUDAPreference does not return correct values
9577   // for functions called in global variable initializers due to missing
9578   // correct context about device/host. Therefore we can only enforce this
9579   // rule when there is a caller. We should enforce this rule for functions
9580   // in global variable initializers once proper context is added.
9581   //
9582   // TODO: We can only enable the hostness based overloading resolution when
9583   // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is on since this requires deferring
9584   // overloading resolution diagnostics.
9585   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9586       S.getLangOpts().GPUExcludeWrongSideOverloads) {
9587     if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) {
9588       bool IsCallerImplicitHD = Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Caller);
9589       bool IsCand1ImplicitHD =
9590           Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Cand1.Function);
9591       bool IsCand2ImplicitHD =
9592           Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Cand2.Function);
9593       auto P1 = S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function);
9594       auto P2 = S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function);
9595       assert(P1 != Sema::CFP_Never && P2 != Sema::CFP_Never);
9596       // The implicit HD function may be a function in a system header which
9597       // is forced by pragma. In device compilation, if we prefer HD candidates
9598       // over wrong-sided candidates, overloading resolution may change, which
9599       // may result in non-deferrable diagnostics. As a workaround, we let
9600       // implicit HD candidates take equal preference as wrong-sided candidates.
9601       // This will preserve the overloading resolution.
9602       // TODO: We still need special handling of implicit HD functions since
9603       // they may incur other diagnostics to be deferred. We should make all
9604       // host/device related diagnostics deferrable and remove special handling
9605       // of implicit HD functions.
9606       auto EmitThreshold =
9607           (S.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice && IsCallerImplicitHD &&
9608            (IsCand1ImplicitHD || IsCand2ImplicitHD))
9609               ? Sema::CFP_Never
9610               : Sema::CFP_WrongSide;
9611       auto Cand1Emittable = P1 > EmitThreshold;
9612       auto Cand2Emittable = P2 > EmitThreshold;
9613       if (Cand1Emittable && !Cand2Emittable)
9614         return true;
9615       if (!Cand1Emittable && Cand2Emittable)
9616         return false;
9617     }
9618   }
9619 
9620   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
9621   //
9622   //   -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
9623   //      that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
9624   //      any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
9625   //      better nor worse than ICS1(F).
9626   unsigned StartArg = 0;
9627   if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
9628     StartArg = 1;
9629 
9630   auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
9631     // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++.
9632     if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
9633       return ICS.isStandard() &&
9634              ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion;
9635 
9636     // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to
9637     // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11.
9638     return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
9639            hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS);
9640   };
9641 
9642   // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given
9643   // argument to be better candidates than functions that do.
9644   unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
9645   assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
9646   bool HasBetterConversion = false;
9647   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
9648     bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]);
9649     bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]);
9650     if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) {
9651       if (Cand1Bad)
9652         return false;
9653       HasBetterConversion = true;
9654     }
9655   }
9656 
9657   if (HasBetterConversion)
9658     return true;
9659 
9660   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
9661   //   A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
9662   //   viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
9663   //   conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
9664   bool HasWorseConversion = false;
9665   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
9666     switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc,
9667                                                Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
9668                                                Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
9669     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
9670       // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
9671       HasBetterConversion = true;
9672       break;
9673 
9674     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
9675       if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9676           Cand1.isReversed() != Cand2.isReversed() &&
9677           haveSameParameterTypes(S.Context, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function,
9678                                  NumArgs)) {
9679         // Work around large-scale breakage caused by considering reversed
9680         // forms of operator== in C++20:
9681         //
9682         // When comparing a function against a reversed function with the same
9683         // parameter types, if we have a better conversion for one argument and
9684         // a worse conversion for the other, the implicit conversion sequences
9685         // are treated as being equally good.
9686         //
9687         // This prevents a comparison function from being considered ambiguous
9688         // with a reversed form that is written in the same way.
9689         //
9690         // We diagnose this as an extension from CreateOverloadedBinOp.
9691         HasWorseConversion = true;
9692         break;
9693       }
9694 
9695       // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
9696       return false;
9697 
9698     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
9699       // Do nothing.
9700       break;
9701     }
9702   }
9703 
9704   //    -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
9705   //       ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
9706   if (HasBetterConversion && !HasWorseConversion)
9707     return true;
9708 
9709   //   -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
9710   //      (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
9711   //      from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
9712   //      the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
9713   //      conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
9714   //      from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
9715   if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion &&
9716       Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9717       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
9718       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
9719     // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
9720     // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
9721     // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
9722     // pointer or block.
9723     ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
9724         compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
9725     if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
9726       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
9727                                                   Cand1.FinalConversion,
9728                                                   Cand2.FinalConversion);
9729 
9730     if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
9731       return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
9732 
9733     // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions
9734     // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per
9735     // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3.
9736   }
9737 
9738   // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 guaranteed copy elision wording,
9739   // as combined with the resolution to CWG issue 243.
9740   //
9741   // When the context is initialization by constructor ([over.match.ctor] or
9742   // either phase of [over.match.list]), a constructor is preferred over
9743   // a conversion function.
9744   if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByConstructor && NumArgs == 1 &&
9745       Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9746       isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function) !=
9747           isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand2.Function))
9748     return isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function);
9749 
9750   //    -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
9751   //       specialization, or, if not that,
9752   bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function &&
9753                                Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9754   bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function &&
9755                                Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9756   if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization)
9757     return Cand2IsSpecialization;
9758 
9759   //   -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
9760   //      template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
9761   //      according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
9762   //      if not that,
9763   if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) {
9764     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(
9765             Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
9766             Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), Loc,
9767             isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) ? TPOC_Conversion
9768                                                    : TPOC_Call,
9769             Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments,
9770             Cand1.isReversed() ^ Cand2.isReversed()))
9771       return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9772   }
9773 
9774   //   -— F1 and F2 are non-template functions with the same
9775   //      parameter-type-lists, and F1 is more constrained than F2 [...],
9776   if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && !Cand1IsSpecialization &&
9777       !Cand2IsSpecialization && Cand1.Function->hasPrototype() &&
9778       Cand2.Function->hasPrototype()) {
9779     auto *PT1 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand1.Function->getFunctionType());
9780     auto *PT2 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand2.Function->getFunctionType());
9781     if (PT1->getNumParams() == PT2->getNumParams() &&
9782         PT1->isVariadic() == PT2->isVariadic() &&
9783         S.FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(PT1, PT2)) {
9784       Expr *RC1 = Cand1.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause();
9785       Expr *RC2 = Cand2.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause();
9786       if (RC1 && RC2) {
9787         bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2;
9788         if (S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand1.Function, {RC1}, Cand2.Function,
9789                                      {RC2}, AtLeastAsConstrained1) ||
9790             S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand2.Function, {RC2}, Cand1.Function,
9791                                      {RC1}, AtLeastAsConstrained2))
9792           return false;
9793         if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 != AtLeastAsConstrained2)
9794           return AtLeastAsConstrained1;
9795       } else if (RC1 || RC2) {
9796         return RC1 != nullptr;
9797       }
9798     }
9799   }
9800 
9801   //   -- F1 is a constructor for a class D, F2 is a constructor for a base
9802   //      class B of D, and for all arguments the corresponding parameters of
9803   //      F1 and F2 have the same type.
9804   // FIXME: Implement the "all parameters have the same type" check.
9805   bool Cand1IsInherited =
9806       dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl());
9807   bool Cand2IsInherited =
9808       dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl());
9809   if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited)
9810     return Cand2IsInherited;
9811   else if (Cand1IsInherited) {
9812     assert(Cand2IsInherited);
9813     auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext());
9814     auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext());
9815     if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class))
9816       return true;
9817     if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class))
9818       return false;
9819     // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous.
9820   }
9821 
9822   //   -- F2 is a rewritten candidate (12.4.1.2) and F1 is not
9823   //   -- F1 and F2 are rewritten candidates, and F2 is a synthesized candidate
9824   //      with reversed order of parameters and F1 is not
9825   //
9826   // We rank reversed + different operator as worse than just reversed, but
9827   // that comparison can never happen, because we only consider reversing for
9828   // the maximally-rewritten operator (== or <=>).
9829   if (Cand1.RewriteKind != Cand2.RewriteKind)
9830     return Cand1.RewriteKind < Cand2.RewriteKind;
9831 
9832   // Check C++17 tie-breakers for deduction guides.
9833   {
9834     auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function);
9835     auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function);
9836     if (Guide1 && Guide2) {
9837       //  -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not
9838       if (Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit())
9839         return Guide2->isImplicit();
9840 
9841       //  -- F1 is the copy deduction candidate(16.3.1.8) and F2 is not
9842       if (Guide1->isCopyDeductionCandidate())
9843         return true;
9844     }
9845   }
9846 
9847   // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution.
9848   if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) {
9849     Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
9850     if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal)
9851       return Cmp == Comparison::Better;
9852   }
9853 
9854   bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr &&
9855                 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function);
9856   bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr &&
9857                 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function);
9858   if (HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1)
9859     return true;
9860 
9861   auto MV = isBetterMultiversionCandidate(Cand1, Cand2);
9862   if (MV == Comparison::Better)
9863     return true;
9864   if (MV == Comparison::Worse)
9865     return false;
9866 
9867   // If other rules cannot determine which is better, CUDA preference is used
9868   // to determine which is better.
9869   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) {
9870     FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9871     return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) >
9872            S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function);
9873   }
9874 
9875   return false;
9876 }
9877 
9878 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of
9879 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no
9880 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including
9881 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to
9882 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both
9883 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using
9884 /// a modularized libstdc++).
9885 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A,
9886                                                   const NamedDecl *B) {
9887   auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A);
9888   auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B);
9889   if (!VA || !VB)
9890     return false;
9891 
9892   // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage
9893   // entity in different modules.
9894   if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
9895           VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) ||
9896       getOwningModule(VA) == getOwningModule(VB) ||
9897       VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible())
9898     return false;
9899 
9900   // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent.
9901   //
9902   // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity.
9903   // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is
9904   // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all.
9905   if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType()))
9906     return true;
9907 
9908   // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but
9909   // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes.
9910   if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) {
9911     if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) {
9912       // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and
9913       // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type.
9914       auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext());
9915       auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext());
9916       if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() ||
9917           !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(),
9918                                EnumB->getIntegerType()))
9919         return false;
9920       // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators.
9921       return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal());
9922     }
9923   }
9924 
9925   // Nothing else is sufficiently similar.
9926   return false;
9927 }
9928 
9929 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(
9930     SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) {
9931   assert(D && "Unknown declaration");
9932   Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D;
9933 
9934   Module *M = getOwningModule(D);
9935   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
9936       << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
9937 
9938   for (auto *E : Equiv) {
9939     Module *M = getOwningModule(E);
9940     Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
9941         << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
9942   }
9943 }
9944 
9945 /// Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
9946 /// within an overload candidate set.
9947 ///
9948 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
9949 /// which overload resolution occurs.
9950 ///
9951 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
9952 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
9953 ///
9954 /// \returns The result of overload resolution.
9955 OverloadingResult
9956 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
9957                                          iterator &Best) {
9958   llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates;
9959   std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates),
9960                  [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; });
9961 
9962   // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but
9963   // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular
9964   // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to
9965   // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based
9966   // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one
9967   // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore
9968   // the WrongSide candidate.
9969   // We only need to remove wrong-sided candidates here if
9970   // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is off. When
9971   // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is on, all candidates are compared
9972   // uniformly in isBetterOverloadCandidate.
9973   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && !S.getLangOpts().GPUExcludeWrongSideOverloads) {
9974     const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9975     bool ContainsSameSideCandidate =
9976         llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9977           // Check viable function only.
9978           return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function &&
9979                  S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) ==
9980                      Sema::CFP_SameSide;
9981         });
9982     if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) {
9983       auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9984         // Check viable function only to avoid unnecessary data copying/moving.
9985         return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function &&
9986                S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) ==
9987                    Sema::CFP_WrongSide;
9988       };
9989       llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate);
9990     }
9991   }
9992 
9993   // Find the best viable function.
9994   Best = end();
9995   for (auto *Cand : Candidates) {
9996     Cand->Best = false;
9997     if (Cand->Viable)
9998       if (Best == end() ||
9999           isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, Kind))
10000         Best = Cand;
10001   }
10002 
10003   // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
10004   if (Best == end())
10005     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
10006 
10007   llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands;
10008 
10009   llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 4> PendingBest;
10010   PendingBest.push_back(&*Best);
10011   Best->Best = true;
10012 
10013   // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
10014   // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
10015   while (!PendingBest.empty()) {
10016     auto *Curr = PendingBest.pop_back_val();
10017     for (auto *Cand : Candidates) {
10018       if (Cand->Viable && !Cand->Best &&
10019           !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Curr, *Cand, Loc, Kind)) {
10020         PendingBest.push_back(Cand);
10021         Cand->Best = true;
10022 
10023         if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Cand->Function,
10024                                                      Curr->Function))
10025           EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function);
10026         else
10027           Best = end();
10028       }
10029     }
10030   }
10031 
10032   // If we found more than one best candidate, this is ambiguous.
10033   if (Best == end())
10034     return OR_Ambiguous;
10035 
10036   // Best is the best viable function.
10037   if (Best->Function && Best->Function->isDeleted())
10038     return OR_Deleted;
10039 
10040   if (!EquivalentCands.empty())
10041     S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function,
10042                                                     EquivalentCands);
10043 
10044   return OR_Success;
10045 }
10046 
10047 namespace {
10048 
10049 enum OverloadCandidateKind {
10050   oc_function,
10051   oc_method,
10052   oc_reversed_binary_operator,
10053   oc_constructor,
10054   oc_implicit_default_constructor,
10055   oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
10056   oc_implicit_move_constructor,
10057   oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
10058   oc_implicit_move_assignment,
10059   oc_implicit_equality_comparison,
10060   oc_inherited_constructor
10061 };
10062 
10063 enum OverloadCandidateSelect {
10064   ocs_non_template,
10065   ocs_template,
10066   ocs_described_template,
10067 };
10068 
10069 static std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect>
10070 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn,
10071                           OverloadCandidateRewriteKind CRK,
10072                           std::string &Description) {
10073 
10074   bool isTemplate = Fn->isTemplateDecl() || Found->isTemplateDecl();
10075   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
10076     isTemplate = true;
10077     Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10078         FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
10079   }
10080 
10081   OverloadCandidateSelect Select = [&]() {
10082     if (!Description.empty())
10083       return ocs_described_template;
10084     return isTemplate ? ocs_template : ocs_non_template;
10085   }();
10086 
10087   OverloadCandidateKind Kind = [&]() {
10088     if (Fn->isImplicit() && Fn->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_EqualEqual)
10089       return oc_implicit_equality_comparison;
10090 
10091     if (CRK & CRK_Reversed)
10092       return oc_reversed_binary_operator;
10093 
10094     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
10095       if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) {
10096         if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found))
10097           return oc_inherited_constructor;
10098         else
10099           return oc_constructor;
10100       }
10101 
10102       if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
10103         return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
10104 
10105       if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
10106         return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
10107 
10108       assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
10109              "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
10110       return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
10111     }
10112 
10113     if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
10114       // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
10115       // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
10116       if (!Meth->isImplicit())
10117         return oc_method;
10118 
10119       if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
10120         return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
10121 
10122       if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
10123         return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
10124 
10125       assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
10126       return oc_method;
10127     }
10128 
10129     return oc_function;
10130   }();
10131 
10132   return std::make_pair(Kind, Select);
10133 }
10134 
10135 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) {
10136   // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload
10137   // set.
10138   if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl))
10139     S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(),
10140            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor)
10141       << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass();
10142 }
10143 
10144 } // end anonymous namespace
10145 
10146 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx,
10147                                     const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10148   for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) {
10149     bool AlwaysTrue;
10150     if (EnableIf->getCond()->isValueDependent() ||
10151         !EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx))
10152       return false;
10153     if (!AlwaysTrue)
10154       return false;
10155   }
10156   return true;
10157 }
10158 
10159 /// Returns true if we can take the address of the function.
10160 ///
10161 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic
10162 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are
10163 ///   we in overload resolution?
10164 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored
10165 ///   if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution.
10166 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD,
10167                                               bool Complain,
10168                                               bool InOverloadResolution,
10169                                               SourceLocation Loc) {
10170   if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) {
10171     if (Complain) {
10172       if (InOverloadResolution)
10173         S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(),
10174                diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr);
10175       else
10176         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD;
10177     }
10178     return false;
10179   }
10180 
10181   if (FD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
10182     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
10183     if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(FD, Satisfaction, Loc))
10184       return false;
10185     if (!Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
10186       if (Complain) {
10187         if (InOverloadResolution)
10188           S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(),
10189                  diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints);
10190         else
10191           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_constraints_not_satisfied)
10192               << FD;
10193         S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction);
10194       }
10195       return false;
10196     }
10197   }
10198 
10199   auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) {
10200     return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
10201   });
10202   if (I == FD->param_end())
10203     return true;
10204 
10205   if (Complain) {
10206     // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing
10207     unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1;
10208     if (InOverloadResolution)
10209       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(),
10210              diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params)
10211           << ParamNo;
10212     else
10213       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params)
10214           << FD << ParamNo;
10215   }
10216   return false;
10217 }
10218 
10219 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S,
10220                                                const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10221   return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true,
10222                                            /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
10223                                            /*Loc=*/SourceLocation());
10224 }
10225 
10226 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function,
10227                                              bool Complain,
10228                                              SourceLocation Loc) {
10229   return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain,
10230                                              /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
10231                                              Loc);
10232 }
10233 
10234 // Don't print candidates other than the one that matches the calling
10235 // convention of the call operator, since that is guaranteed to exist.
10236 static bool shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
10237   const auto *ConvD = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Fn);
10238 
10239   if (!ConvD)
10240     return false;
10241   const auto *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Fn->getParent());
10242   if (!RD->isLambda())
10243     return false;
10244 
10245   CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = RD->getLambdaCallOperator();
10246   CallingConv CallOpCC =
10247       CallOp->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
10248   QualType ConvRTy = ConvD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType();
10249   CallingConv ConvToCC =
10250       ConvRTy->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
10251 
10252   return ConvToCC != CallOpCC;
10253 }
10254 
10255 // Notes the location of an overload candidate.
10256 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn,
10257                                  OverloadCandidateRewriteKind RewriteKind,
10258                                  QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) {
10259   if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn))
10260     return;
10261   if (Fn->isMultiVersion() && Fn->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
10262       !Fn->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion())
10263     return;
10264   if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Fn))
10265     return;
10266 
10267   std::string FnDesc;
10268   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> KSPair =
10269       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, RewriteKind, FnDesc);
10270   PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
10271                          << (unsigned)KSPair.first << (unsigned)KSPair.second
10272                          << Fn << FnDesc;
10273 
10274   HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
10275   Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
10276   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found);
10277 }
10278 
10279 static void
10280 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(Sema &S, ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate> Cands) {
10281   // Perhaps the ambiguity was caused by two atomic constraints that are
10282   // 'identical' but not equivalent:
10283   //
10284   // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) { } // #1
10285   // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) && T::value { } // #2
10286   //
10287   // The 'sizeof(T) > 4' constraints are seemingly equivalent and should cause
10288   // #2 to subsume #1, but these constraint are not considered equivalent
10289   // according to the subsumption rules because they are not the same
10290   // source-level construct. This behavior is quite confusing and we should try
10291   // to help the user figure out what happened.
10292 
10293   SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> FirstAC, SecondAC;
10294   FunctionDecl *FirstCand = nullptr, *SecondCand = nullptr;
10295   for (auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
10296     if (!I->Function)
10297       continue;
10298     SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> AC;
10299     if (auto *Template = I->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
10300       Template->getAssociatedConstraints(AC);
10301     else
10302       I->Function->getAssociatedConstraints(AC);
10303     if (AC.empty())
10304       continue;
10305     if (FirstCand == nullptr) {
10306       FirstCand = I->Function;
10307       FirstAC = AC;
10308     } else if (SecondCand == nullptr) {
10309       SecondCand = I->Function;
10310       SecondAC = AC;
10311     } else {
10312       // We have more than one pair of constrained functions - this check is
10313       // expensive and we'd rather not try to diagnose it.
10314       return;
10315     }
10316   }
10317   if (!SecondCand)
10318     return;
10319   // The diagnostic can only happen if there are associated constraints on
10320   // both sides (there needs to be some identical atomic constraint).
10321   if (S.MaybeEmitAmbiguousAtomicConstraintsDiagnostic(FirstCand, FirstAC,
10322                                                       SecondCand, SecondAC))
10323     // Just show the user one diagnostic, they'll probably figure it out
10324     // from here.
10325     return;
10326 }
10327 
10328 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
10329 // OverloadedExpr
10330 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType,
10331                                      bool TakingAddress) {
10332   assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10333 
10334   OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
10335   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
10336 
10337   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
10338                             IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
10339        I != IEnd; ++I) {
10340     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
10341                 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
10342       NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), CRK_None, DestType,
10343                             TakingAddress);
10344     } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
10345                       = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
10346       NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, DestType, TakingAddress);
10347     }
10348   }
10349 }
10350 
10351 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion.  The partial diagnostic is the
10352 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
10353 /// target types of the conversion.
10354 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
10355                                  Sema &S,
10356                                  SourceLocation CaretLoc,
10357                                  const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
10358   S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
10359     << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
10360   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
10361   AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
10362   for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
10363     if (CandsShown >= S.Diags.getNumOverloadCandidatesToShow())
10364       break;
10365     ++CandsShown;
10366     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second);
10367   }
10368   S.Diags.overloadCandidatesShown(CandsShown);
10369   if (I != E)
10370     S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
10371 }
10372 
10373 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10374                                   unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10375   const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
10376   assert(Conv.isBad());
10377   assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
10378   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
10379 
10380   // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
10381   // non-constructor method.  Note that 'I' corresponds the
10382   // conversion-slot index.
10383   bool isObjectArgument = false;
10384   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
10385     if (I == 0)
10386       isObjectArgument = true;
10387     else
10388       I--;
10389   }
10390 
10391   std::string FnDesc;
10392   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
10393       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind(),
10394                                 FnDesc);
10395 
10396   Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
10397   QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
10398   QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
10399 
10400   if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
10401     assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
10402     Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
10403     if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
10404       E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
10405     DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
10406 
10407     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
10408         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10409         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << ToTy
10410         << Name << I + 1;
10411     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10412     return;
10413   }
10414 
10415   // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
10416   // to a qualifier mismatch.
10417   CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
10418   CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
10419   if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
10420     CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
10421   else {
10422     // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
10423     if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
10424       if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10425         CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType();
10426         CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
10427       }
10428   }
10429 
10430   if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
10431       !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
10432     Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
10433     Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
10434 
10435     if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
10436       if (isObjectArgument)
10437         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace_this)
10438             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10439             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10440             << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace();
10441       else
10442         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
10443             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10444             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10445             << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
10446             << ToTy->isReferenceType() << I + 1;
10447       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10448       return;
10449     }
10450 
10451     if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
10452       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
10453           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10454           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10455           << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
10456           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10457       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10458       return;
10459     }
10460 
10461     if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
10462       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
10463           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10464           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10465           << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
10466           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10467       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10468       return;
10469     }
10470 
10471     if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) {
10472       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned)
10473           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10474           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10475           << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I + 1;
10476       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10477       return;
10478     }
10479 
10480     unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
10481     assert(CVR && "expected qualifiers mismatch");
10482 
10483     if (isObjectArgument) {
10484       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
10485           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10486           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10487           << (CVR - 1);
10488     } else {
10489       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
10490           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10491           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10492           << (CVR - 1) << I + 1;
10493     }
10494     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10495     return;
10496   }
10497 
10498   if (Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue ||
10499       Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue) {
10500     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_value_category)
10501         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10502         << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10503         << (Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue)
10504         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
10505     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10506     return;
10507   }
10508 
10509   // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
10510   // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
10511   if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
10512     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
10513         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10514         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10515         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10516     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10517     return;
10518   }
10519 
10520   // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
10521   // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
10522   // the failure.
10523   QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
10524   if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
10525     TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
10526   if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
10527     // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
10528     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
10529         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10530         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10531         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10532         << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind);
10533 
10534     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10535     return;
10536   }
10537 
10538   // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
10539   unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
10540   if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10541     if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10542       if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
10543                                                FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
10544           !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10545           !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10546           S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
10547                           FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
10548         BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
10549     }
10550   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
10551                                     = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
10552     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
10553                                         = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
10554       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
10555         if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
10556           if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
10557                                                 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
10558               FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
10559             BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
10560   } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
10561     if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
10562         !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
10563         !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10564         S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
10565       BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
10566     }
10567   }
10568 
10569   if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
10570     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
10571         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10572         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10573         << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) << FromTy << ToTy << I + 1;
10574     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10575     return;
10576   }
10577 
10578   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
10579       isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
10580       Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
10581       Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
10582       if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
10583         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
10584             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10585             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10586             << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10587         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10588         return;
10589       }
10590   }
10591 
10592   if (TakingCandidateAddress &&
10593       !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function))
10594     return;
10595 
10596   // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
10597   PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
10598   FDiag << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10599         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10600         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10601         << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind);
10602 
10603   // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
10604   for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
10605        HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
10606     FDiag << *HI;
10607   S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
10608 
10609   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10610 }
10611 
10612 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload
10613 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch()
10614 /// over a candidate in any candidate set.
10615 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10616                                unsigned NumArgs) {
10617   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
10618   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
10619 
10620   // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
10621   // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the
10622   // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
10623   // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
10624   // Just don't report anything.
10625   if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
10626       Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
10627     return true;
10628 
10629   if (NumArgs < MinParams) {
10630     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
10631            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
10632             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
10633   } else {
10634     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
10635            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
10636             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
10637   }
10638 
10639   return false;
10640 }
10641 
10642 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set.
10643 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D,
10644                                   unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
10645   assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
10646       "The templated declaration should at least be a function"
10647       " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many"
10648       " or too few arguments");
10649 
10650   FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
10651 
10652   // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
10653   const auto *FnTy = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10654   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
10655 
10656   // at least / at most / exactly
10657   unsigned mode, modeCount;
10658   if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
10659     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() ||
10660         FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
10661       mode = 0; // "at least"
10662     else
10663       mode = 2; // "exactly"
10664     modeCount = MinParams;
10665   } else {
10666     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams())
10667       mode = 1; // "at most"
10668     else
10669       mode = 2; // "exactly"
10670     modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams();
10671   }
10672 
10673   std::string Description;
10674   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
10675       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, CRK_None, Description);
10676 
10677   if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
10678     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
10679         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10680         << Description << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
10681   else
10682     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
10683         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10684         << Description << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
10685 
10686   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10687 }
10688 
10689 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate.
10690 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10691                                   unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
10692   if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs))
10693     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs);
10694 }
10695 
10696 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) {
10697   if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate())
10698     return TD;
10699   llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration"
10700                    " for bad deduction diagnosis");
10701 }
10702 
10703 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
10704 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated,
10705                                  DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure,
10706                                  unsigned NumArgs,
10707                                  bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10708   TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
10709   NamedDecl *ParamD;
10710   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
10711   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
10712   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
10713   switch (DeductionFailure.Result) {
10714   case Sema::TDK_Success:
10715     llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
10716 
10717   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
10718     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
10719     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10720            diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
10721         << ParamD->getDeclName();
10722     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10723     return;
10724   }
10725 
10726   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: {
10727     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
10728     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10729            diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction_pack)
10730         << ParamD->getDeclName()
10731         << (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() + 1)
10732         << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
10733     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10734     return;
10735   }
10736 
10737   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
10738     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
10739     TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
10740 
10741     QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
10742 
10743     // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
10744     // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
10745     QualifierCollector Qs;
10746     Qs.strip(Param);
10747     QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
10748     assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
10749 
10750     // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
10751     // about that.  It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
10752     // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
10753     // done on dependent types).
10754     QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
10755 
10756     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
10757         << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
10758     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10759     return;
10760   }
10761 
10762   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
10763     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
10764     int which = 0;
10765     if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
10766       which = 0;
10767     else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) {
10768       // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two
10769       // different types for a non-type template parameter.
10770       // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this.
10771       QualType T1 =
10772           DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType();
10773       QualType T2 =
10774           DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType();
10775       if (!T1.isNull() && !T2.isNull() && !S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) {
10776         S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10777                diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types)
10778           << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1
10779           << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2;
10780         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10781         return;
10782       }
10783 
10784       which = 1;
10785     } else {
10786       which = 2;
10787     }
10788 
10789     // Tweak the diagnostic if the problem is that we deduced packs of
10790     // different arities. We'll print the actual packs anyway in case that
10791     // includes additional useful information.
10792     if (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack &&
10793         DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack &&
10794         DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() !=
10795             DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->pack_size()) {
10796       which = 3;
10797     }
10798 
10799     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10800            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
10801         << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
10802         << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
10803     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10804     return;
10805   }
10806 
10807   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
10808     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
10809     if (ParamD->getDeclName())
10810       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10811              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
10812           << ParamD->getDeclName();
10813     else {
10814       int index = 0;
10815       if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
10816         index = TTP->getIndex();
10817       else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
10818                                   = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
10819         index = NTTP->getIndex();
10820       else
10821         index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
10822       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10823              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
10824           << (index + 1);
10825     }
10826     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10827     return;
10828 
10829   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: {
10830     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10831     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10832     TemplateArgumentList *Args = DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList();
10833     TemplateArgString = " ";
10834     TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10835         getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10836     if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10837       TemplateArgString.clear();
10838     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10839            diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints)
10840         << TemplateArgString;
10841 
10842     S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(
10843         static_cast<CNSInfo*>(DeductionFailure.Data)->Satisfaction);
10844     return;
10845   }
10846   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
10847   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
10848     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs);
10849     return;
10850 
10851   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
10852     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10853            diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
10854     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10855     return;
10856 
10857   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
10858     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10859     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10860     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
10861             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
10862       TemplateArgString = " ";
10863       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10864           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10865       if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10866         TemplateArgString.clear();
10867     }
10868 
10869     // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
10870     PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
10871     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
10872           diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
10873       // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
10874       //        name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
10875       S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
10876         << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
10877       return;
10878     }
10879 
10880     // We found a specific requirement that disabled the enable_if.
10881     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
10882         diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_requirement) {
10883       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10884              diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_requirement)
10885         << PDiag->second.getStringArg(0) << TemplateArgString;
10886       return;
10887     }
10888 
10889     // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
10890     // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
10891     //        formatted message in another diagnostic.
10892     SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
10893     SourceRange R;
10894     if (PDiag) {
10895       SFINAEArgString = ": ";
10896       R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
10897       PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
10898     }
10899 
10900     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10901            diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
10902         << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
10903     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10904     return;
10905   }
10906 
10907   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
10908   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: {
10909     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10910     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10911     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
10912             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
10913       TemplateArgString = " ";
10914       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10915           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10916       if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10917         TemplateArgString.clear();
10918     }
10919 
10920     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch)
10921         << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1)
10922         << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()
10923         << TemplateArgString
10924         << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested);
10925     break;
10926   }
10927 
10928   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
10929     // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
10930     TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
10931     TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
10932     if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
10933         SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
10934       TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
10935       TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
10936       if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
10937           SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
10938         if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
10939             SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
10940           // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
10941           // the same.  This particular case is a bit difficult since:
10942           // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
10943           // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
10944           //    name for types, not decls.
10945           // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
10946           S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10947                  diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
10948               << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
10949           return;
10950         }
10951       }
10952     }
10953 
10954     if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) &&
10955         !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated)))
10956       return;
10957 
10958     // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda
10959     // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative
10960     // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to
10961     // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters.
10962     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10963            diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
10964         << FirstTA << SecondTA;
10965     return;
10966   }
10967   // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
10968   // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
10969   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
10970     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
10971     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10972     return;
10973   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
10974     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10975            diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch);
10976     return;
10977   }
10978 }
10979 
10980 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls.
10981 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10982                                  unsigned NumArgs,
10983                                  bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10984   unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result;
10985   if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) {
10986     if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs))
10987       return;
10988   }
10989   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern
10990                        Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress);
10991 }
10992 
10993 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
10994 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
10995   FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
10996   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
10997 
10998   Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
10999                            CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
11000 
11001   std::string FnDesc;
11002   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
11003       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee,
11004                                 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
11005 
11006   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
11007       << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template
11008       << FnDesc /* Ignored */
11009       << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
11010 
11011   // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the
11012   // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case.
11013   CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee);
11014   if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) {
11015     CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent();
11016     Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM;
11017 
11018     switch (FnKindPair.first) {
11019     default:
11020       return;
11021     case oc_implicit_default_constructor:
11022       CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor;
11023       break;
11024     case oc_implicit_copy_constructor:
11025       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor;
11026       break;
11027     case oc_implicit_move_constructor:
11028       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor;
11029       break;
11030     case oc_implicit_copy_assignment:
11031       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment;
11032       break;
11033     case oc_implicit_move_assignment:
11034       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment;
11035       break;
11036     };
11037 
11038     bool ConstRHS = false;
11039     if (Meth->getNumParams()) {
11040       if (const ReferenceType *RT =
11041               Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
11042         ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified();
11043       }
11044     }
11045 
11046     S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth,
11047                                               /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS,
11048                                               /* Diagnose */ true);
11049   }
11050 }
11051 
11052 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11053   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
11054   EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data);
11055 
11056   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
11057          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
11058       << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
11059 }
11060 
11061 static void DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11062   ExplicitSpecifier ES = ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Cand->Function);
11063   assert(ES.isExplicit() && "not an explicit candidate");
11064 
11065   unsigned Kind;
11066   switch (Cand->Function->getDeclKind()) {
11067   case Decl::Kind::CXXConstructor:
11068     Kind = 0;
11069     break;
11070   case Decl::Kind::CXXConversion:
11071     Kind = 1;
11072     break;
11073   case Decl::Kind::CXXDeductionGuide:
11074     Kind = Cand->Function->isImplicit() ? 0 : 2;
11075     break;
11076   default:
11077     llvm_unreachable("invalid Decl");
11078   }
11079 
11080   // Note the location of the first (in-class) declaration; a redeclaration
11081   // (particularly an out-of-class definition) will typically lack the
11082   // 'explicit' specifier.
11083   // FIXME: This is probably a good thing to do for all 'candidate' notes.
11084   FunctionDecl *First = Cand->Function->getFirstDecl();
11085   if (FunctionDecl *Pattern = First->getTemplateInstantiationPattern())
11086     First = Pattern->getFirstDecl();
11087 
11088   S.Diag(First->getLocation(),
11089          diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit)
11090       << Kind << (ES.getExpr() ? 1 : 0)
11091       << (ES.getExpr() ? ES.getExpr()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
11092 }
11093 
11094 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11095   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
11096 
11097   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
11098          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension)
11099     << S.getOpenCLExtensionsFromDeclExtMap(Callee);
11100 }
11101 
11102 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate.  We've
11103 /// already generated a primary error at the call site.
11104 ///
11105 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
11106 /// pointed at the candidate declaration.  Yes, this creates some
11107 /// major challenges of technical writing.  Yes, this makes pointing
11108 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward.  It's still
11109 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
11110 /// overload.
11111 ///
11112 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
11113 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
11114 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
11115 /// \param CtorDestAS Addr space of object being constructed (for ctor
11116 /// candidates only).
11117 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
11118                                   unsigned NumArgs,
11119                                   bool TakingCandidateAddress,
11120                                   LangAS CtorDestAS = LangAS::Default) {
11121   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
11122   if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Fn))
11123     return;
11124 
11125   // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
11126   if (Cand->Viable) {
11127     if (Fn->isDeleted()) {
11128       std::string FnDesc;
11129       std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
11130           ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn,
11131                                     Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
11132 
11133       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
11134           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
11135           << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
11136       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11137       return;
11138     }
11139 
11140     // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
11141     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11142     return;
11143   }
11144 
11145   switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
11146   case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
11147   case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
11148     return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
11149 
11150   case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
11151     return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs,
11152                                 TakingCandidateAddress);
11153 
11154   case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: {
11155     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor)
11156       << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0);
11157     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11158     return;
11159   }
11160 
11161   case ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch: {
11162     Qualifiers QualsForPrinting;
11163     QualsForPrinting.setAddressSpace(CtorDestAS);
11164     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11165            diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor_adrspace_mismatch)
11166         << QualsForPrinting;
11167     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11168     return;
11169   }
11170 
11171   case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
11172   case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
11173   case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
11174     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11175 
11176   case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
11177     unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
11178     for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
11179       if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
11180         return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress);
11181 
11182     // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
11183     // when user-conversion overload fails.  Figure out how to handle
11184     // those conditions and diagnose them well.
11185     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11186   }
11187 
11188   case ovl_fail_bad_target:
11189     return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
11190 
11191   case ovl_fail_enable_if:
11192     return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand);
11193 
11194   case ovl_fail_explicit:
11195     return DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(S, Cand);
11196 
11197   case ovl_fail_ext_disabled:
11198     return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand);
11199 
11200   case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice:
11201     // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here.
11202     if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor())
11203       return;
11204     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11205            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice)
11206       << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0)
11207       << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType();
11208     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11209     return;
11210 
11211   case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: {
11212     bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function);
11213     (void)Available;
11214     assert(!Available);
11215     break;
11216   }
11217   case ovl_non_default_multiversion_function:
11218     // Do nothing, these should simply be ignored.
11219     break;
11220 
11221   case ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied: {
11222     std::string FnDesc;
11223     std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
11224         ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn,
11225                                   Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
11226 
11227     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11228            diag::note_ovl_candidate_constraints_not_satisfied)
11229         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template
11230         << FnDesc /* Ignored */;
11231     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
11232     if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(Fn, Satisfaction))
11233       break;
11234     S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction);
11235   }
11236   }
11237 }
11238 
11239 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11240   if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Cand->Surrogate))
11241     return;
11242 
11243   // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
11244   // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
11245   // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
11246   QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
11247   bool isLValueReference = false;
11248   bool isRValueReference = false;
11249   bool isPointer = false;
11250   if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
11251         FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
11252     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11253     isLValueReference = true;
11254   } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
11255                FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
11256     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11257     isRValueReference = true;
11258   }
11259   if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
11260     FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11261     isPointer = true;
11262   }
11263   // Desugar down to a function type.
11264   FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
11265   // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
11266   if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
11267   if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
11268   if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
11269 
11270   S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
11271     << FnType;
11272 }
11273 
11274 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc,
11275                                          SourceLocation OpLoc,
11276                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11277   assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
11278   std::string TypeStr("operator");
11279   TypeStr += Opc;
11280   TypeStr += "(";
11281   TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString();
11282   if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
11283     TypeStr += ")";
11284     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr;
11285   } else {
11286     TypeStr += ", ";
11287     TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString();
11288     TypeStr += ")";
11289     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr;
11290   }
11291 }
11292 
11293 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11294                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11295   for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) {
11296     if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
11297     if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
11298 
11299     ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
11300         S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
11301   }
11302 }
11303 
11304 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11305   if (Cand->Function)
11306     return Cand->Function->getLocation();
11307   if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
11308     return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
11309   return SourceLocation();
11310 }
11311 
11312 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
11313   switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
11314   case Sema::TDK_Success:
11315   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
11316     llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction");
11317 
11318   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
11319   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
11320   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
11321     return 1;
11322 
11323   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
11324   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
11325     return 2;
11326 
11327   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
11328   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
11329   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
11330   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
11331   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
11332   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
11333   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
11334     return 3;
11335 
11336   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
11337     return 4;
11338 
11339   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
11340     return 5;
11341 
11342   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
11343   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
11344     return 6;
11345   }
11346   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
11347 }
11348 
11349 namespace {
11350 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
11351   Sema &S;
11352   SourceLocation Loc;
11353   size_t NumArgs;
11354   OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK;
11355 
11356   CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(
11357       Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t NArgs,
11358       OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK)
11359       : S(S), NumArgs(NArgs), CSK(CSK) {}
11360 
11361   OverloadFailureKind EffectiveFailureKind(const OverloadCandidate *C) const {
11362     // If there are too many or too few arguments, that's the high-order bit we
11363     // want to sort by, even if the immediate failure kind was something else.
11364     if (C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11365         C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
11366       return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind);
11367 
11368     if (C->Function) {
11369       if (NumArgs > C->Function->getNumParams() && !C->Function->isVariadic())
11370         return ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
11371       if (NumArgs < C->Function->getMinRequiredArguments())
11372         return ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
11373     }
11374 
11375     return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind);
11376   }
11377 
11378   bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
11379                   const OverloadCandidate *R) {
11380     // Fast-path this check.
11381     if (L == R) return false;
11382 
11383     // Order first by viability.
11384     if (L->Viable) {
11385       if (!R->Viable) return true;
11386 
11387       // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
11388       // candidates.  Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
11389       // that could exploit it.
11390       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation(), CSK))
11391         return true;
11392       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation(), CSK))
11393         return false;
11394     } else if (R->Viable)
11395       return false;
11396 
11397     assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
11398 
11399     // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
11400     if (!L->Viable) {
11401       OverloadFailureKind LFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(L);
11402       OverloadFailureKind RFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(R);
11403 
11404       // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
11405       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11406           LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
11407         if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11408             RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
11409           int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
11410           int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
11411           if (LDist == RDist) {
11412             if (LFailureKind == RFailureKind)
11413               // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates.
11414               return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate;
11415             // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were
11416             // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters
11417             // than there were arguments given.
11418             return LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
11419           }
11420           return LDist < RDist;
11421         }
11422         return false;
11423       }
11424       if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11425           RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
11426         return true;
11427 
11428       // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
11429       // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
11430       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
11431         if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11432           return true;
11433 
11434         // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
11435         // comes first.
11436         unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
11437         unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
11438         numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
11439         numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
11440         if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
11441           return numLFixes < numRFixes;
11442         }
11443 
11444         // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
11445         // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
11446         assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
11447 
11448         int leftBetter = 0;
11449         unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
11450         for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
11451           switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc,
11452                                                      L->Conversions[I],
11453                                                      R->Conversions[I])) {
11454           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
11455             leftBetter++;
11456             break;
11457 
11458           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
11459             leftBetter--;
11460             break;
11461 
11462           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
11463             break;
11464           }
11465         }
11466         if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
11467         if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
11468 
11469       } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11470         return false;
11471 
11472       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
11473         if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
11474           return true;
11475 
11476         if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
11477           return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
11478                < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
11479       } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
11480         return false;
11481 
11482       // TODO: others?
11483     }
11484 
11485     // Sort everything else by location.
11486     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
11487     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
11488 
11489     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
11490     if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
11491     if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
11492 
11493     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
11494   }
11495 };
11496 }
11497 
11498 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
11499 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if
11500 /// possible.
11501 static void
11502 CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
11503                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11504                            OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) {
11505   assert(!Cand->Viable);
11506 
11507   // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
11508   if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11509     return;
11510 
11511   // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
11512   bool Unfixable = false;
11513   // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
11514   Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
11515 
11516   // Attempt to fix the bad conversion.
11517   unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
11518   for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/;
11519        ++ConvIdx) {
11520     assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
11521     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
11522         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
11523       Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
11524       break;
11525     }
11526   }
11527 
11528   // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
11529   // operation somehow.
11530   bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
11531 
11532   unsigned ConvIdx = 0;
11533   unsigned ArgIdx = 0;
11534   ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes;
11535   bool Reversed = Cand->isReversed();
11536 
11537   if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
11538     QualType ConvType
11539       = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
11540     if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
11541       ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
11542     ParamTypes = ConvType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes();
11543     // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11544     ConvIdx = 1;
11545   } else if (Cand->Function) {
11546     ParamTypes =
11547         Cand->Function->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes();
11548     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
11549         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function) && !Reversed) {
11550       // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11551       ConvIdx = 1;
11552       if (CSK == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
11553           Cand->Function->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Call)
11554         // Argument 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11555         ArgIdx = 1;
11556     }
11557   } else {
11558     // Builtin operator.
11559     assert(ConvCount <= 3);
11560     ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes;
11561   }
11562 
11563   // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
11564   for (unsigned ParamIdx = Reversed ? ParamTypes.size() - 1 : 0;
11565        ConvIdx != ConvCount;
11566        ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx, ParamIdx += (Reversed ? -1 : 1)) {
11567     assert(ArgIdx < Args.size() && "no argument for this arg conversion");
11568     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
11569       // We've already checked this conversion.
11570     } else if (ParamIdx < ParamTypes.size()) {
11571       if (ParamTypes[ParamIdx]->isDependentType())
11572         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion(
11573             Args[ArgIdx]->getType());
11574       else {
11575         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] =
11576             TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ParamIdx],
11577                                   SuppressUserConversions,
11578                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
11579                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
11580                                   S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
11581         // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
11582         if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
11583           Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
11584       }
11585     } else
11586       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
11587   }
11588 }
11589 
11590 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 32> OverloadCandidateSet::CompleteCandidates(
11591     Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11592     SourceLocation OpLoc,
11593     llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) {
11594   // Sort the candidates by viability and position.  Sorting directly would
11595   // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
11596   SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
11597   if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
11598   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
11599     if (!Filter(*Cand))
11600       continue;
11601     switch (OCD) {
11602     case OCD_AllCandidates:
11603       if (!Cand->Viable) {
11604         if (!Cand->Function && !Cand->IsSurrogate) {
11605           // This a non-viable builtin candidate.  We do not, in general,
11606           // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
11607           continue;
11608         }
11609         CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, Kind);
11610       }
11611       break;
11612 
11613     case OCD_ViableCandidates:
11614       if (!Cand->Viable)
11615         continue;
11616       break;
11617 
11618     case OCD_AmbiguousCandidates:
11619       if (!Cand->Best)
11620         continue;
11621       break;
11622     }
11623 
11624     Cands.push_back(Cand);
11625   }
11626 
11627   llvm::stable_sort(
11628       Cands, CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size(), Kind));
11629 
11630   return Cands;
11631 }
11632 
11633 bool OverloadCandidateSet::shouldDeferDiags(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11634                                             SourceLocation OpLoc) {
11635   bool DeferHint = false;
11636   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && S.getLangOpts().GPUDeferDiag) {
11637     // Defer diagnostic for CUDA/HIP if there are wrong-sided candidates or
11638     // host device candidates.
11639     auto WrongSidedCands =
11640         CompleteCandidates(S, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, OpLoc, [](auto &Cand) {
11641           return (Cand.Viable == false &&
11642                   Cand.FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_target) ||
11643                  (Cand.Function->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>() &&
11644                   Cand.Function->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>());
11645         });
11646     DeferHint = !WrongSidedCands.empty();
11647   }
11648   return DeferHint;
11649 }
11650 
11651 /// When overload resolution fails, prints diagnostic messages containing the
11652 /// candidates in the candidate set.
11653 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(
11654     PartialDiagnosticAt PD, Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
11655     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11656     llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) {
11657 
11658   auto Cands = CompleteCandidates(S, OCD, Args, OpLoc, Filter);
11659 
11660   S.Diag(PD.first, PD.second, shouldDeferDiags(S, Args, OpLoc));
11661 
11662   NoteCandidates(S, Args, Cands, Opc, OpLoc);
11663 
11664   if (OCD == OCD_AmbiguousCandidates)
11665     MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(S, {begin(), end()});
11666 }
11667 
11668 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11669                                           ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate *> Cands,
11670                                           StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
11671   bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
11672 
11673   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
11674   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
11675   auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end();
11676   for (; I != E; ++I) {
11677     OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
11678 
11679     if (CandsShown >= S.Diags.getNumOverloadCandidatesToShow() &&
11680         ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
11681       break;
11682     }
11683     ++CandsShown;
11684 
11685     if (Cand->Function)
11686       NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(),
11687                             /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false, DestAS);
11688     else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
11689       NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
11690     else {
11691       assert(Cand->Viable &&
11692              "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
11693       // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
11694       // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
11695       // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
11696       //
11697       // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
11698       // different ambiguities, though.
11699       if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
11700         NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
11701         ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
11702       }
11703 
11704       // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
11705       NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
11706     }
11707   }
11708 
11709   // Inform S.Diags that we've shown an overload set with N elements.  This may
11710   // inform the future value of S.Diags.getNumOverloadCandidatesToShow().
11711   S.Diags.overloadCandidatesShown(CandsShown);
11712 
11713   if (I != E)
11714     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates,
11715            shouldDeferDiags(S, Args, OpLoc))
11716         << int(E - I);
11717 }
11718 
11719 static SourceLocation
11720 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) {
11721   return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation()
11722                               : SourceLocation();
11723 }
11724 
11725 namespace {
11726 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay {
11727   Sema &S;
11728   CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
11729 
11730   bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L,
11731                   const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) {
11732     // Fast-path this check.
11733     if (L == R)
11734       return false;
11735 
11736     // Assuming that both candidates are not matches...
11737 
11738     // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures.
11739     if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
11740       return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) <
11741              RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
11742 
11743     // Sort everything else by location.
11744     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
11745     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
11746 
11747     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
11748     if (LLoc.isInvalid())
11749       return false;
11750     if (RLoc.isInvalid())
11751       return true;
11752 
11753     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
11754   }
11755 };
11756 }
11757 
11758 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure.
11759 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad
11760 /// deductions.
11761 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S,
11762                                                  bool ForTakingAddress) {
11763   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern
11764                        DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress);
11765 }
11766 
11767 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
11768   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
11769     i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
11770   }
11771 }
11772 
11773 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() {
11774   destroyCandidates();
11775   Candidates.clear();
11776 }
11777 
11778 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints
11779 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form
11780 /// the candidate set.
11781 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with
11782 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false.
11783 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
11784   // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match).
11785   // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers
11786   // and sort those.
11787   SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands;
11788   Cands.reserve(size());
11789   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
11790     if (Cand->Specialization)
11791       Cands.push_back(Cand);
11792     // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate.  We do not,
11793     // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate.
11794   }
11795 
11796   llvm::sort(Cands, CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S));
11797 
11798   // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads()
11799   // for generalization purposes (?).
11800   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
11801 
11802   SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E;
11803   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
11804   for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
11805     TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I;
11806 
11807     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam
11808     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
11809     // candidate list.
11810     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
11811       break;
11812     ++CandsShown;
11813 
11814     assert(Cand->Specialization &&
11815            "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
11816     Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress);
11817   }
11818 
11819   if (I != E)
11820     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
11821 }
11822 
11823 // [PossiblyAFunctionType]  -->   [Return]
11824 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
11825 // R (A) --> R(A)
11826 // R (*)(A) --> R (A)
11827 // R (&)(A) --> R (A)
11828 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
11829 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
11830   QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
11831   if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
11832     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
11833     Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11834   else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
11835     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
11836     Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11837   else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
11838     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
11839     Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11840   Ret =
11841     Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
11842   return Ret;
11843 }
11844 
11845 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc,
11846                                  bool Complain = true) {
11847   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
11848       S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain))
11849     return true;
11850 
11851   auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11852   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
11853       isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) &&
11854       !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT))
11855     return true;
11856 
11857   return false;
11858 }
11859 
11860 namespace {
11861 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution
11862 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
11863 class AddressOfFunctionResolver {
11864   Sema& S;
11865   Expr* SourceExpr;
11866   const QualType& TargetType;
11867   QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
11868 
11869   bool Complain;
11870   //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
11871   ASTContext& Context;
11872 
11873   bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
11874   bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
11875   bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
11876   bool HasComplained;
11877 
11878   OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
11879   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
11880   TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
11881   SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
11882   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates;
11883 
11884 public:
11885   AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr,
11886                             const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain)
11887       : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
11888         Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
11889         TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
11890             !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
11891         FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
11892         StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false),
11893         HasComplained(false),
11894         OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
11895         OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression),
11896         FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) {
11897     ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
11898 
11899     if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
11900       if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr))
11901         if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() &&
11902             !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME))
11903           StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true;
11904     } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11905       DeclAccessPair dap;
11906       if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
11907               OvlExpr, false, &dap)) {
11908         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn))
11909           if (!Method->isStatic()) {
11910             // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found
11911             // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the
11912             // target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
11913             TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
11914 
11915             // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
11916             // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
11917             if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
11918               return;
11919           }
11920 
11921         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn));
11922       }
11923       return;
11924     }
11925 
11926     if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
11927       OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
11928 
11929     if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
11930       // C++ [over.over]p4:
11931       //   If more than one function is selected, [...]
11932       if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) {
11933         if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
11934           EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
11935         else
11936           EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
11937       }
11938     }
11939 
11940     if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1)
11941       EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches();
11942   }
11943 
11944   bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; }
11945 
11946 private:
11947   bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
11948     QualType Discard;
11949     return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) ||
11950            S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard);
11951   }
11952 
11953   /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the
11954   /// desired type than B.
11955   bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) {
11956     // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it
11957     // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to
11958     // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match.
11959     return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) &&
11960            (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) ||
11961             compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better);
11962   }
11963 
11964   /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate,
11965   /// false otherwise.
11966   bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() {
11967     // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best",
11968     // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best.
11969     auto Best = Matches.begin();
11970     for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I)
11971       if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second))
11972         Best = I;
11973 
11974     const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second;
11975     auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn](
11976         const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) {
11977       return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second);
11978     };
11979 
11980     // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best
11981     // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error
11982     if (!llvm::all_of(Matches, IsBestOrInferiorToBest))
11983       return false;
11984     Matches[0] = *Best;
11985     Matches.resize(1);
11986     return true;
11987   }
11988 
11989   bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
11990     return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
11991   }
11992 
11993   // [ToType]     [Return]
11994 
11995   // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
11996   // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
11997   // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
11998   void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
11999     TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
12000   }
12001 
12002   // return true if any matching specializations were found
12003   bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
12004                                    const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
12005     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
12006               = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
12007       // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
12008       // static when converting to member pointer.
12009       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12010         return false;
12011     }
12012     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12013       return false;
12014 
12015     // C++ [over.over]p2:
12016     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
12017     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
12018     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
12019     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
12020     //   overloaded functions considered.
12021     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
12022     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
12023     if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
12024           = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
12025                                       &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
12026                                       TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
12027                                       Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) {
12028       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
12029       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
12030           .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
12031                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
12032       return false;
12033     }
12034 
12035     // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
12036     // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
12037     // This function template specicalization works.
12038     assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
12039               Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
12040               Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)));
12041 
12042     if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization))
12043       return false;
12044 
12045     Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
12046     return true;
12047   }
12048 
12049   bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
12050                                       const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
12051     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
12052       // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
12053       // when converting to member pointer.
12054       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12055         return false;
12056     }
12057     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12058       return false;
12059 
12060     if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
12061       if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
12062         if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
12063           if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl))
12064             return false;
12065       if (FunDecl->isMultiVersion()) {
12066         const auto *TA = FunDecl->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
12067         if (TA && !TA->isDefaultVersion())
12068           return false;
12069       }
12070 
12071       // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction
12072       // now.
12073       if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(),
12074                                Complain)) {
12075         HasComplained |= Complain;
12076         return false;
12077       }
12078 
12079       if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl))
12080         return false;
12081 
12082       // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical.
12083       if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
12084           candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) {
12085         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(
12086             CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
12087         FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
12088         return true;
12089       }
12090     }
12091 
12092     return false;
12093   }
12094 
12095   bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
12096     bool Ret = false;
12097 
12098     // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
12099     // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
12100     if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
12101       return false;
12102 
12103     for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
12104                                E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
12105          I != E; ++I) {
12106       // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
12107       NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
12108 
12109       // C++ [over.over]p3:
12110       //   Non-member functions and static member functions match
12111       //   targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
12112       //   Nonstatic member functions match targets of
12113       //   type "pointer-to-member-function."
12114       // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
12115       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
12116                                         = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
12117         if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
12118           Ret = true;
12119       }
12120       // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
12121       else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
12122                AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
12123         Ret = true;
12124     }
12125     assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
12126     return Ret;
12127   }
12128 
12129   void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
12130     //   [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
12131     //   eliminated if the set contains a second function template
12132     //   specialization whose function template is more specialized
12133     //   than the function template of F1 according to the partial
12134     //   ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
12135 
12136     // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
12137     // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
12138     // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
12139     // best function template (if it exists).
12140 
12141     UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
12142     for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
12143       MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
12144 
12145     // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose
12146     // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0.
12147     UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized(
12148         MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates,
12149         SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), S.PDiag(),
12150         S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12151             << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
12152         S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
12153             << (unsigned)oc_function << (unsigned)ocs_described_template,
12154         Complain, TargetFunctionType);
12155 
12156     if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
12157       // Make it the first and only element
12158       Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
12159       Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
12160       Matches.resize(1);
12161     } else
12162       HasComplained |= Complain;
12163   }
12164 
12165   void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
12166     //   [...] any function template specializations in the set are
12167     //   eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
12168     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
12169       if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr)
12170         ++I;
12171       else {
12172         Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
12173         Matches.resize(N);
12174       }
12175     }
12176   }
12177 
12178   void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() {
12179     S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches);
12180   }
12181 
12182 public:
12183   void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
12184     assert(Matches.empty());
12185     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
12186         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
12187         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12188     if (FailedCandidates.empty())
12189       S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
12190                                   /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12191     else {
12192       // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose
12193       // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates
12194       // normally.
12195       for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
12196                                  IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
12197            I != IEnd; ++I)
12198         if (FunctionDecl *Fun =
12199                 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
12200           if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun))
12201             S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, TargetFunctionType,
12202                                     /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12203       FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getBeginLoc());
12204     }
12205   }
12206 
12207   bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
12208     return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
12209       !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
12210   }
12211 
12212   void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
12213       // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
12214       // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
12215       // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
12216       S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
12217         << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12218   }
12219 
12220   bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
12221     return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
12222   }
12223 
12224   void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
12225     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(),
12226            diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
12227         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12228   }
12229 
12230   void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
12231     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
12232         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
12233   }
12234 
12235   void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
12236     assert(Matches.size() > 1);
12237     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12238         << OvlExpr->getName() << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12239     S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
12240                                 /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12241   }
12242 
12243   bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
12244 
12245   int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
12246 
12247   FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
12248     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
12249     return Matches[0].second;
12250   }
12251 
12252   const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
12253     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
12254     return &Matches[0].first;
12255   }
12256 };
12257 }
12258 
12259 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
12260 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
12261 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
12262 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
12263 ///
12264 /// @code
12265 /// int f(double);
12266 /// int f(int);
12267 ///
12268 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
12269 /// @endcode
12270 ///
12271 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
12272 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
12273 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
12274 FunctionDecl *
12275 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
12276                                          QualType TargetType,
12277                                          bool Complain,
12278                                          DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
12279                                          bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
12280   assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
12281 
12282   AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
12283                                      Complain);
12284   int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
12285   FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr;
12286   bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained();
12287   if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) {
12288     if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
12289       Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
12290     else
12291       Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
12292   }
12293   else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain)
12294     Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
12295   else if (NumMatches == 1) {
12296     Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
12297     assert(Fn);
12298     if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
12299       ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT);
12300     FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
12301     if (Complain) {
12302       if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer())
12303         Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer();
12304       else
12305         CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
12306     }
12307   }
12308 
12309   if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
12310     *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
12311   return Fn;
12312 }
12313 
12314 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
12315 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken.
12316 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null.
12317 ///
12318 /// This routine can only succeed if from all of the candidates in the overload
12319 /// set for SrcExpr that can have their addresses taken, there is one candidate
12320 /// that is more constrained than the rest.
12321 FunctionDecl *
12322 Sema::resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair &Pair) {
12323   OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E);
12324   OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression;
12325   bool IsResultAmbiguous = false;
12326   FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr;
12327   DeclAccessPair DAP;
12328   SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 2> AmbiguousDecls;
12329 
12330   auto CheckMoreConstrained =
12331       [&] (FunctionDecl *FD1, FunctionDecl *FD2) -> Optional<bool> {
12332         SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> AC1, AC2;
12333         FD1->getAssociatedConstraints(AC1);
12334         FD2->getAssociatedConstraints(AC2);
12335         bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2;
12336         if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD1, AC1, FD2, AC2, AtLeastAsConstrained1))
12337           return None;
12338         if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD2, AC2, FD1, AC1, AtLeastAsConstrained2))
12339           return None;
12340         if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 == AtLeastAsConstrained2)
12341           return None;
12342         return AtLeastAsConstrained1;
12343       };
12344 
12345   // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for
12346   // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks
12347   // enable_if/pass_object_size/...
12348   for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12349     auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl());
12350     if (!FD)
12351       return nullptr;
12352 
12353     if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD))
12354       continue;
12355 
12356     // We have more than one result - see if it is more constrained than the
12357     // previous one.
12358     if (Result) {
12359       Optional<bool> MoreConstrainedThanPrevious = CheckMoreConstrained(FD,
12360                                                                         Result);
12361       if (!MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) {
12362         IsResultAmbiguous = true;
12363         AmbiguousDecls.push_back(FD);
12364         continue;
12365       }
12366       if (!*MoreConstrainedThanPrevious)
12367         continue;
12368       // FD is more constrained - replace Result with it.
12369     }
12370     IsResultAmbiguous = false;
12371     DAP = I.getPair();
12372     Result = FD;
12373   }
12374 
12375   if (IsResultAmbiguous)
12376     return nullptr;
12377 
12378   if (Result) {
12379     SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> ResultAC;
12380     // We skipped over some ambiguous declarations which might be ambiguous with
12381     // the selected result.
12382     for (FunctionDecl *Skipped : AmbiguousDecls)
12383       if (!CheckMoreConstrained(Skipped, Result).hasValue())
12384         return nullptr;
12385     Pair = DAP;
12386   }
12387   return Result;
12388 }
12389 
12390 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded
12391 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate. This
12392 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if
12393 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay.
12394 ///
12395 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate fails.
12396 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true.
12397 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(
12398     ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) {
12399   Expr *E = SrcExpr.get();
12400   assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload");
12401 
12402   DeclAccessPair DAP;
12403   FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(E, DAP);
12404   if (!Found || Found->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() ||
12405       Found->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion())
12406     return false;
12407 
12408   // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and
12409   // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check
12410   // for both.
12411   DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc());
12412   CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP);
12413   Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found);
12414   if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType())
12415     SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false);
12416   else
12417     SrcExpr = Fixed;
12418   return true;
12419 }
12420 
12421 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
12422 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
12423 ///
12424 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
12425 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
12426 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
12427 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
12428 ///
12429 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is
12430 /// returned.
12431 FunctionDecl *
12432 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
12433                                                   bool Complain,
12434                                                   DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
12435   // C++ [over.over]p1:
12436   //   [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
12437   //   overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
12438   // C++ [over.over]p1:
12439   //   [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
12440   //   operator.
12441 
12442   // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
12443   if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
12444     return nullptr;
12445 
12446   TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
12447   ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
12448   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc());
12449 
12450   // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
12451   // whose type matches exactly.
12452   FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr;
12453   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
12454          E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12455     // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
12456     //   [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
12457     //   where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
12458     //   specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
12459     //   identifies a single function template specialization, then the
12460     //   template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
12461     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
12462       = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
12463 
12464     // C++ [over.over]p2:
12465     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
12466     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
12467     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
12468     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
12469     //   overloaded functions considered.
12470     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
12471     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
12472     if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
12473           = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12474                                     Specialization, Info,
12475                                     /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) {
12476       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
12477       // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info?
12478       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
12479           .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
12480                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
12481       continue;
12482     }
12483 
12484     assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
12485 
12486     // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
12487     if (Matched) {
12488       if (Complain) {
12489         Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12490           << ovl->getName();
12491         NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
12492       }
12493       return nullptr;
12494     }
12495 
12496     Matched = Specialization;
12497     if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
12498   }
12499 
12500   if (Matched &&
12501       completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain))
12502     return nullptr;
12503 
12504   return Matched;
12505 }
12506 
12507 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
12508 // because it identifies a single function template specialization.
12509 //
12510 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
12511 //
12512 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
12513 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded.  Always
12514 // returns true if 'complain' is set.
12515 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
12516                       ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
12517                       bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining,
12518                                            QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
12519                                             unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
12520   assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
12521 
12522   OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
12523 
12524   DeclAccessPair found;
12525   ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
12526   if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
12527                            ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
12528     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getBeginLoc())) {
12529       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12530       return true;
12531     }
12532 
12533     // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
12534     // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
12535     // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
12536     // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
12537     if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
12538         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
12539         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
12540       if (!complain) return false;
12541 
12542       Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
12543            diag::err_bound_member_function)
12544         << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
12545 
12546       // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
12547       // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
12548       // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
12549       // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
12550       // the static candidates were rejected.
12551       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12552       return true;
12553     }
12554 
12555     // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
12556     SingleFunctionExpression =
12557         FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn);
12558 
12559     // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
12560     if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
12561       SingleFunctionExpression =
12562         DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get());
12563       if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
12564         SrcExpr = ExprError();
12565         return true;
12566       }
12567     }
12568   }
12569 
12570   if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
12571     if (complain) {
12572       Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
12573         << ovl.Expression->getName()
12574         << DestTypeForComplaining
12575         << OpRangeForComplaining
12576         << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
12577       NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
12578 
12579       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12580       return true;
12581     }
12582 
12583     return false;
12584   }
12585 
12586   SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
12587   return true;
12588 }
12589 
12590 /// Add a single candidate to the overload set.
12591 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
12592                                        DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
12593                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12594                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12595                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
12596                                        bool PartialOverloading,
12597                                        bool KnownValid) {
12598   NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
12599   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
12600     Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
12601 
12602   if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
12603     if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
12604       assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
12605       return;
12606     }
12607     // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates.
12608     if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()))
12609       return;
12610 
12611     S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
12612                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
12613                            PartialOverloading);
12614     return;
12615   }
12616 
12617   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
12618       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
12619     S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
12620                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet,
12621                                    /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
12622                                    PartialOverloading);
12623     return;
12624   }
12625 
12626   assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
12627 }
12628 
12629 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
12630 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
12631 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12632                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12633                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
12634                                        bool PartialOverloading) {
12635 
12636 #ifndef NDEBUG
12637   // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
12638   // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
12639   //
12640   //   Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
12641   //   and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
12642   //   lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
12643   //
12644   //     -- a declaration of a class member, or
12645   //
12646   //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
12647   //        using-declaration, or
12648   //
12649   //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
12650   //        template
12651   //
12652   //   then Y is empty.
12653 
12654   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
12655     for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
12656            E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12657       assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
12658       assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
12659              !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
12660       assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
12661     }
12662   }
12663 #endif
12664 
12665   // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
12666   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
12667   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
12668   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12669     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
12670     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
12671   }
12672 
12673   for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
12674          E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
12675     AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
12676                                CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
12677                                /*KnownValid*/ true);
12678 
12679   if (ULE->requiresADL())
12680     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(),
12681                                          Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12682                                          CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
12683 }
12684 
12685 /// Add the call candidates from the given set of lookup results to the given
12686 /// overload set. Non-function lookup results are ignored.
12687 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(
12688     LookupResult &R, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12689     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
12690   for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
12691     AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
12692                                CandidateSet, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
12693 }
12694 
12695 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into
12696 /// a different namespace.
12697 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) {
12698   switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) {
12699   case OO_New: case OO_Array_New:
12700   case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete:
12701     return false;
12702 
12703   default:
12704     return true;
12705   }
12706 }
12707 
12708 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
12709 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
12710 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
12711 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
12712 ///
12713 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
12714 static bool DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(
12715     Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
12716     LookupResult &R, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK,
12717     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12718     CXXRecordDecl **FoundInClass = nullptr) {
12719   if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty())
12720     return false;
12721 
12722   for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
12723     if (DC->isTransparentContext())
12724       continue;
12725 
12726     SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
12727 
12728     if (!R.empty()) {
12729       R.suppressDiagnostics();
12730 
12731       OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK);
12732       SemaRef.AddOverloadedCallCandidates(R, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
12733                                           Candidates);
12734 
12735       OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12736       OverloadingResult OR =
12737           Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best);
12738 
12739       if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
12740         // We either found non-function declarations or a best viable function
12741         // at class scope. A class-scope lookup result disables ADL. Don't
12742         // look past this, but let the caller know that we found something that
12743         // either is, or might be, usable in this class.
12744         if (FoundInClass) {
12745           *FoundInClass = RD;
12746           if (OR == OR_Success) {
12747             R.clear();
12748             R.addDecl(Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(), Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
12749             R.resolveKind();
12750           }
12751         }
12752         return false;
12753       }
12754 
12755       if (OR != OR_Success) {
12756         // There wasn't a unique best function or function template.
12757         return false;
12758       }
12759 
12760       // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
12761       // declaring the function there instead.
12762       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
12763       Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
12764       SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
12765                                                  AssociatedNamespaces,
12766                                                  AssociatedClasses);
12767       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
12768       if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) {
12769         DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
12770         for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
12771                it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
12772                end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
12773           // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
12774           if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
12775             continue;
12776 
12777           // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a
12778           // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx.
12779           NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
12780           if (NS &&
12781               NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
12782             continue;
12783 
12784           SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
12785         }
12786       }
12787 
12788       SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12789         << R.getLookupName();
12790       if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
12791         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12792                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12793           << R.getLookupName() << 0;
12794       } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
12795         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12796                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12797           << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
12798       } else {
12799         // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
12800         // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
12801         // a localized representation of a list of items.
12802         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12803                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12804           << R.getLookupName() << 2;
12805       }
12806 
12807       // Try to recover by calling this function.
12808       return true;
12809     }
12810 
12811     R.clear();
12812   }
12813 
12814   return false;
12815 }
12816 
12817 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
12818 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
12819 /// was defined.
12820 ///
12821 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
12822 static bool
12823 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
12824                                SourceLocation OpLoc,
12825                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
12826   DeclarationName OpName =
12827     SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
12828   LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
12829   return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
12830                                 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
12831                                 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args);
12832 }
12833 
12834 namespace {
12835 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
12836   Sema &SemaRef;
12837 public:
12838   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
12839     assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
12840     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
12841   }
12842 
12843   ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
12844     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
12845   }
12846 };
12847 
12848 }
12849 
12850 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
12851 ///
12852 /// This function will do one of three things:
12853 ///  * Diagnose, recover, and return a recovery expression.
12854 ///  * Diagnose, fail to recover, and return ExprError().
12855 ///  * Do not diagnose, do not recover, and return ExprResult(). The caller is
12856 ///    expected to diagnose as appropriate.
12857 static ExprResult
12858 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
12859                       UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12860                       SourceLocation LParenLoc,
12861                       MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12862                       SourceLocation RParenLoc,
12863                       bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
12864   // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
12865   // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
12866   //
12867   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
12868   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
12869   if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
12870     return ExprResult();
12871   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
12872 
12873   CXXScopeSpec SS;
12874   SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
12875   SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
12876 
12877   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
12878   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
12879   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12880     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
12881     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
12882   }
12883 
12884   LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
12885                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
12886   CXXRecordDecl *FoundInClass = nullptr;
12887   if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
12888                              OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal,
12889                              ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, &FoundInClass)) {
12890     // OK, diagnosed a two-phase lookup issue.
12891   } else if (EmptyLookup) {
12892     // Try to recover from an empty lookup with typo correction.
12893     R.clear();
12894     NoTypoCorrectionCCC NoTypoValidator{};
12895     FunctionCallFilterCCC FunctionCallValidator(SemaRef, Args.size(),
12896                                                 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr,
12897                                                 dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn));
12898     CorrectionCandidateCallback &Validator =
12899         AllowTypoCorrection
12900             ? static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(FunctionCallValidator)
12901             : static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(NoTypoValidator);
12902     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Validator, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12903                                     Args))
12904       return ExprError();
12905   } else if (FoundInClass && SemaRef.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
12906     // We found a usable declaration of the name in a dependent base of some
12907     // enclosing class.
12908     // FIXME: We should also explain why the candidates found by name lookup
12909     // were not viable.
12910     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseDependentMemberLookup(R))
12911       return ExprError();
12912   } else {
12913     // We had viable candidates and couldn't recover; let the caller diagnose
12914     // this.
12915     return ExprResult();
12916   }
12917 
12918   // If we get here, we should have issued a diagnostic and formed a recovery
12919   // lookup result.
12920   assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
12921 
12922   // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out.
12923   if (R.isAmbiguous()) {
12924     R.suppressDiagnostics();
12925     return ExprError();
12926   }
12927 
12928   // Build an implicit member call if appropriate.  Just drop the
12929   // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
12930   ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
12931   if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
12932     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R,
12933                                                     ExplicitTemplateArgs, S);
12934   else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
12935     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
12936                                         ExplicitTemplateArgs);
12937   else
12938     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
12939 
12940   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
12941     return ExprError();
12942 
12943   // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
12944   // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
12945   // end up here.
12946   return SemaRef.BuildCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc,
12947                                MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
12948                                RParenLoc);
12949 }
12950 
12951 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
12952 /// the given function.
12953 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
12954 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
12955                                   UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12956                                   MultiExprArg Args,
12957                                   SourceLocation RParenLoc,
12958                                   OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
12959                                   ExprResult *Result) {
12960 #ifndef NDEBUG
12961   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
12962     // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
12963     assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
12964 
12965     // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
12966     // Verify that this was correctly set up.
12967     FunctionDecl *F;
12968     if (ULE->decls_begin() != ULE->decls_end() &&
12969         ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
12970         (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
12971         F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
12972       llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
12973 
12974     // We don't perform ADL in C.
12975     assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
12976   }
12977 #endif
12978 
12979   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
12980   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) {
12981     *Result = ExprError();
12982     return true;
12983   }
12984 
12985   // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
12986   // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
12987   AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet);
12988 
12989   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
12990       CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() &&
12991       (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
12992 
12993     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12994     if (CandidateSet->empty() ||
12995         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best) ==
12996             OR_No_Viable_Function) {
12997       // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function
12998       // then create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name
12999       // lookup to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent
13000       // base classes.
13001       CallExpr *CE =
13002           CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
13003                            RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13004       CE->markDependentForPostponedNameLookup();
13005       *Result = CE;
13006       return true;
13007     }
13008   }
13009 
13010   if (CandidateSet->empty())
13011     return false;
13012 
13013   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
13014   return false;
13015 }
13016 
13017 // Guess at what the return type for an unresolvable overload should be.
13018 static QualType chooseRecoveryType(OverloadCandidateSet &CS,
13019                                    OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best) {
13020   llvm::Optional<QualType> Result;
13021   // Adjust Type after seeing a candidate.
13022   auto ConsiderCandidate = [&](const OverloadCandidate &Candidate) {
13023     if (!Candidate.Function)
13024       return;
13025     if (Candidate.Function->isInvalidDecl())
13026       return;
13027     QualType T = Candidate.Function->getReturnType();
13028     if (T.isNull())
13029       return;
13030     if (!Result)
13031       Result = T;
13032     else if (Result != T)
13033       Result = QualType();
13034   };
13035 
13036   // Look for an unambiguous type from a progressively larger subset.
13037   // e.g. if types disagree, but all *viable* overloads return int, choose int.
13038   //
13039   // First, consider only the best candidate.
13040   if (Best && *Best != CS.end())
13041     ConsiderCandidate(**Best);
13042   // Next, consider only viable candidates.
13043   if (!Result)
13044     for (const auto &C : CS)
13045       if (C.Viable)
13046         ConsiderCandidate(C);
13047   // Finally, consider all candidates.
13048   if (!Result)
13049     for (const auto &C : CS)
13050       ConsiderCandidate(C);
13051 
13052   if (!Result)
13053     return QualType();
13054   auto Value = Result.getValue();
13055   if (Value.isNull() || Value->isUndeducedType())
13056     return QualType();
13057   return Value;
13058 }
13059 
13060 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
13061 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
13062 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
13063 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
13064                                            UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
13065                                            SourceLocation LParenLoc,
13066                                            MultiExprArg Args,
13067                                            SourceLocation RParenLoc,
13068                                            Expr *ExecConfig,
13069                                            OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
13070                                            OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
13071                                            OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
13072                                            bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
13073   switch (OverloadResult) {
13074   case OR_Success: {
13075     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
13076     SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
13077     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
13078       return ExprError();
13079     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
13080     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13081                                          ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false,
13082                                          (*Best)->IsADLCandidate);
13083   }
13084 
13085   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
13086     // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
13087     // have meant to call.
13088     ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
13089                                                 Args, RParenLoc,
13090                                                 CandidateSet->empty(),
13091                                                 AllowTypoCorrection);
13092     if (Recovery.isInvalid() || Recovery.isUsable())
13093       return Recovery;
13094 
13095     // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we
13096     // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to
13097     // emit better ones.
13098     for (const Expr *Arg : Args) {
13099       if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType())
13100         continue;
13101       if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) {
13102         auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
13103         if (FD &&
13104             !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true,
13105                                                        Arg->getExprLoc()))
13106           return ExprError();
13107       }
13108     }
13109 
13110     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13111         PartialDiagnosticAt(
13112             Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13113             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
13114                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13115         SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
13116     break;
13117   }
13118 
13119   case OR_Ambiguous:
13120     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13121         PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13122                             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
13123                                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13124         SemaRef, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
13125     break;
13126 
13127   case OR_Deleted: {
13128     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13129         PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13130                             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
13131                                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13132         SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
13133 
13134     // We emitted an error for the unavailable/deleted function call but keep
13135     // the call in the AST.
13136     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
13137     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
13138     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13139                                          ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false,
13140                                          (*Best)->IsADLCandidate);
13141   }
13142   }
13143 
13144   // Overload resolution failed, try to recover.
13145   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> SubExprs = {Fn};
13146   SubExprs.append(Args.begin(), Args.end());
13147   return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(Fn->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs,
13148                                     chooseRecoveryType(*CandidateSet, Best));
13149 }
13150 
13151 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S,
13152                                                 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) {
13153   for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) {
13154     if (I->Viable &&
13155         !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) {
13156       I->Viable = false;
13157       I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available;
13158     }
13159   }
13160 }
13161 
13162 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
13163 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
13164 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
13165 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
13166 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
13167 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
13168 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
13169                                          UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
13170                                          SourceLocation LParenLoc,
13171                                          MultiExprArg Args,
13172                                          SourceLocation RParenLoc,
13173                                          Expr *ExecConfig,
13174                                          bool AllowTypoCorrection,
13175                                          bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) {
13176   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(),
13177                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
13178   ExprResult result;
13179 
13180   if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet,
13181                              &result))
13182     return result;
13183 
13184   // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that
13185   // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable.
13186   if (CalleesAddressIsTaken)
13187     markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet);
13188 
13189   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13190   OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
13191       CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best);
13192 
13193   return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13194                                   ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, &Best,
13195                                   OverloadResult, AllowTypoCorrection);
13196 }
13197 
13198 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
13199   return Functions.size() > 1 ||
13200          (Functions.size() == 1 &&
13201           isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*Functions.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
13202 }
13203 
13204 ExprResult Sema::CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass,
13205                                             NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLoc,
13206                                             DeclarationNameInfo DNI,
13207                                             const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13208                                             bool PerformADL) {
13209   return UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, NNSLoc, DNI,
13210                                       PerformADL, IsOverloaded(Fns),
13211                                       Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
13212 }
13213 
13214 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
13215 /// operator.
13216 ///
13217 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
13218 ///
13219 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
13220 ///
13221 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
13222 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
13223 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
13224 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
13225 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
13226 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
13227 ///
13228 /// \param Input The input argument.
13229 ExprResult
13230 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
13231                               const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13232                               Expr *Input, bool PerformADL) {
13233   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
13234   assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
13235   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13236   // TODO: provide better source location info.
13237   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
13238 
13239   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
13240     return ExprError();
13241 
13242   Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr };
13243   unsigned NumArgs = 1;
13244 
13245   // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
13246   // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
13247   // post-decrement.
13248   if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
13249     llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
13250     Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
13251                                      SourceLocation());
13252     NumArgs = 2;
13253   }
13254 
13255   ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs);
13256 
13257   if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
13258     if (Fns.empty())
13259       return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy,
13260                                    VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, false,
13261                                    CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13262 
13263     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
13264     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
13265         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns);
13266     if (Fn.isInvalid())
13267       return ExprError();
13268     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), ArgsArray,
13269                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc,
13270                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13271   }
13272 
13273   // Build an empty overload set.
13274   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
13275 
13276   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
13277   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13278 
13279   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
13280   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13281 
13282   // Add candidates from ADL.
13283   if (PerformADL) {
13284     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray,
13285                                          /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr,
13286                                          CandidateSet);
13287   }
13288 
13289   // Add builtin operator candidates.
13290   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13291 
13292   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13293 
13294   // Perform overload resolution.
13295   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13296   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
13297   case OR_Success: {
13298     // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
13299     FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
13300 
13301     if (FnDecl) {
13302       Expr *Base = nullptr;
13303       // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
13304       // operator.
13305 
13306       // Convert the arguments.
13307       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13308         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
13309 
13310         ExprResult InputRes =
13311           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
13312                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
13313         if (InputRes.isInvalid())
13314           return ExprError();
13315         Base = Input = InputRes.get();
13316       } else {
13317         // Convert the arguments.
13318         ExprResult InputInit
13319           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
13320                                                       Context,
13321                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13322                                       SourceLocation(),
13323                                       Input);
13324         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
13325           return ExprError();
13326         Input = InputInit.get();
13327       }
13328 
13329       // Build the actual expression node.
13330       ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
13331                                                 Base, HadMultipleCandidates,
13332                                                 OpLoc);
13333       if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
13334         return ExprError();
13335 
13336       // Determine the result type.
13337       QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
13338       ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
13339       ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
13340 
13341       Args[0] = Input;
13342       CallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
13343           Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
13344           CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate);
13345 
13346       if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
13347         return ExprError();
13348 
13349       if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall,
13350                             FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
13351         return ExprError();
13352       return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), FnDecl);
13353     } else {
13354       // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
13355       // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
13356       // operator node.
13357       ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion(
13358           Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing,
13359           CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13360       if (InputRes.isInvalid())
13361         return ExprError();
13362       Input = InputRes.get();
13363       break;
13364     }
13365   }
13366 
13367   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
13368     // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
13369     // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
13370     // defined too late to be candidates.
13371     if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray))
13372       // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
13373       return ExprError();
13374 
13375     // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
13376     // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
13377     break;
13378 
13379   case OR_Ambiguous:
13380     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13381         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc,
13382                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
13383                                 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13384                                 << Input->getType() << Input->getSourceRange()),
13385         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, ArgsArray,
13386         UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
13387     return ExprError();
13388 
13389   case OR_Deleted:
13390     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13391         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
13392                                        << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13393                                        << Input->getSourceRange()),
13394         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13395         OpLoc);
13396     return ExprError();
13397   }
13398 
13399   // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
13400   // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
13401   // build a built-in operation.
13402   return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
13403 }
13404 
13405 /// Perform lookup for an overloaded binary operator.
13406 void Sema::LookupOverloadedBinOp(OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
13407                                  OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
13408                                  const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13409                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, bool PerformADL) {
13410   SourceLocation OpLoc = CandidateSet.getLocation();
13411 
13412   OverloadedOperatorKind ExtraOp =
13413       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().AllowRewrittenCandidates
13414           ? getRewrittenOverloadedOperator(Op)
13415           : OO_None;
13416 
13417   // Add the candidates from the given function set. This also adds the
13418   // rewritten candidates using these functions if necessary.
13419   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet);
13420 
13421   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
13422   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13423   if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Op))
13424     AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet,
13425                                 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
13426 
13427   // In C++20, also add any rewritten member candidates.
13428   if (ExtraOp) {
13429     AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13430     if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(ExtraOp))
13431       AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]},
13432                                   CandidateSet,
13433                                   OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
13434   }
13435 
13436   // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not
13437   // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->,
13438   // which don't get here).
13439   if (Op != OO_Equal && PerformADL) {
13440     DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13441     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args,
13442                                          /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
13443                                          CandidateSet);
13444     if (ExtraOp) {
13445       DeclarationName ExtraOpName =
13446           Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(ExtraOp);
13447       AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ExtraOpName, OpLoc, Args,
13448                                            /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
13449                                            CandidateSet);
13450     }
13451   }
13452 
13453   // Add builtin operator candidates.
13454   //
13455   // FIXME: We don't add any rewritten candidates here. This is strictly
13456   // incorrect; a builtin candidate could be hidden by a non-viable candidate,
13457   // resulting in our selecting a rewritten builtin candidate. For example:
13458   //
13459   //   enum class E { e };
13460   //   bool operator!=(E, E) requires false;
13461   //   bool k = E::e != E::e;
13462   //
13463   // ... should select the rewritten builtin candidate 'operator==(E, E)'. But
13464   // it seems unreasonable to consider rewritten builtin candidates. A core
13465   // issue has been filed proposing to removed this requirement.
13466   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13467 }
13468 
13469 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
13470 /// operator.
13471 ///
13472 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
13473 ///
13474 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
13475 ///
13476 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
13477 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
13478 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
13479 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
13480 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
13481 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
13482 ///
13483 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
13484 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
13485 /// \param PerformADL Whether to consider operator candidates found by ADL.
13486 /// \param AllowRewrittenCandidates Whether to consider candidates found by
13487 ///        C++20 operator rewrites.
13488 /// \param DefaultedFn If we are synthesizing a defaulted operator function,
13489 ///        the function in question. Such a function is never a candidate in
13490 ///        our overload resolution. This also enables synthesizing a three-way
13491 ///        comparison from < and == as described in C++20 [class.spaceship]p1.
13492 ExprResult Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
13493                                        BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
13494                                        const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS,
13495                                        Expr *RHS, bool PerformADL,
13496                                        bool AllowRewrittenCandidates,
13497                                        FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) {
13498   Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
13499   LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
13500 
13501   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
13502     AllowRewrittenCandidates = false;
13503 
13504   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
13505 
13506   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
13507   // expression.
13508   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
13509     if (Fns.empty()) {
13510       // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
13511       // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
13512       if (BinaryOperator::isCompoundAssignmentOp(Opc))
13513         return CompoundAssignOperator::Create(
13514             Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue,
13515             OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Context.DependentTy,
13516             Context.DependentTy);
13517       return BinaryOperator::Create(Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
13518                                     Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
13519                                     OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13520     }
13521 
13522     // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
13523     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
13524     // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
13525     DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13526     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
13527     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
13528         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns, PerformADL);
13529     if (Fn.isInvalid())
13530       return ExprError();
13531     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), Args,
13532                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc,
13533                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13534   }
13535 
13536   // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
13537   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
13538     return ExprError();
13539 
13540   // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
13541   // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
13542   assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
13543   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
13544     return ExprError();
13545 
13546   // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
13547   // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
13548   // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
13549   // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
13550   // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
13551   // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
13552   if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
13553     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13554 
13555   // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
13556   // create a built-in binary operator.
13557   if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
13558     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13559 
13560   // Build the overload set.
13561   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(
13562       OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
13563       OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo(Op, AllowRewrittenCandidates));
13564   if (DefaultedFn)
13565     CandidateSet.exclude(DefaultedFn);
13566   LookupOverloadedBinOp(CandidateSet, Op, Fns, Args, PerformADL);
13567 
13568   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13569 
13570   // Perform overload resolution.
13571   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13572   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
13573     case OR_Success: {
13574       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
13575       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
13576 
13577       bool IsReversed = Best->isReversed();
13578       if (IsReversed)
13579         std::swap(Args[0], Args[1]);
13580 
13581       if (FnDecl) {
13582         Expr *Base = nullptr;
13583         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
13584         // operator.
13585 
13586         OverloadedOperatorKind ChosenOp =
13587             FnDecl->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator();
13588 
13589         // C++2a [over.match.oper]p9:
13590         //   If a rewritten operator== candidate is selected by overload
13591         //   resolution for an operator@, its return type shall be cv bool
13592         if (Best->RewriteKind && ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual &&
13593             !FnDecl->getReturnType()->isBooleanType()) {
13594           bool IsExtension =
13595               FnDecl->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
13596           Diag(OpLoc, IsExtension ? diag::ext_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool
13597                                   : diag::err_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool)
13598               << FnDecl->getReturnType() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13599               << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13600           Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
13601           if (!IsExtension)
13602             return ExprError();
13603         }
13604 
13605         if (AllowRewrittenCandidates && !IsReversed &&
13606             CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isReversible()) {
13607           // We could have reversed this operator, but didn't. Check if some
13608           // reversed form was a viable candidate, and if so, if it had a
13609           // better conversion for either parameter. If so, this call is
13610           // formally ambiguous, and allowing it is an extension.
13611           llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl*, 4> AmbiguousWith;
13612           for (OverloadCandidate &Cand : CandidateSet) {
13613             if (Cand.Viable && Cand.Function && Cand.isReversed() &&
13614                 haveSameParameterTypes(Context, Cand.Function, FnDecl, 2)) {
13615               for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
13616                 if (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(
13617                         *this, OpLoc, Cand.Conversions[ArgIdx],
13618                         Best->Conversions[ArgIdx]) ==
13619                     ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) {
13620                   AmbiguousWith.push_back(Cand.Function);
13621                   break;
13622                 }
13623               }
13624             }
13625           }
13626 
13627           if (!AmbiguousWith.empty()) {
13628             bool AmbiguousWithSelf =
13629                 AmbiguousWith.size() == 1 &&
13630                 declaresSameEntity(AmbiguousWith.front(), FnDecl);
13631             Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed)
13632                 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13633                 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() << AmbiguousWithSelf
13634                 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13635             if (AmbiguousWithSelf) {
13636               Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(),
13637                    diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_self);
13638             } else {
13639               Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(),
13640                    diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_selected_candidate);
13641               for (auto *F : AmbiguousWith)
13642                 Diag(F->getLocation(),
13643                      diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_candidate);
13644             }
13645           }
13646         }
13647 
13648         // Convert the arguments.
13649         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13650           // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
13651           CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
13652 
13653           ExprResult Arg1 =
13654             PerformCopyInitialization(
13655               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13656                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13657               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
13658           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
13659             return ExprError();
13660 
13661           ExprResult Arg0 =
13662             PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
13663                                                 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
13664           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
13665             return ExprError();
13666           Base = Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
13667           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
13668         } else {
13669           // Convert the arguments.
13670           ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
13671             InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13672                                                    FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13673             SourceLocation(), Args[0]);
13674           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
13675             return ExprError();
13676 
13677           ExprResult Arg1 =
13678             PerformCopyInitialization(
13679               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13680                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
13681               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
13682           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
13683             return ExprError();
13684           Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
13685           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
13686         }
13687 
13688         // Build the actual expression node.
13689         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
13690                                                   Best->FoundDecl, Base,
13691                                                   HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
13692         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
13693           return ExprError();
13694 
13695         // Determine the result type.
13696         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
13697         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
13698         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
13699 
13700         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
13701             Context, ChosenOp, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
13702             CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate);
13703 
13704         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
13705                                 FnDecl))
13706           return ExprError();
13707 
13708         ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
13709         const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr;
13710         // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
13711         if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13712           ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0];
13713           ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
13714         }
13715 
13716         // Check for a self move.
13717         if (Op == OO_Equal)
13718           DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc);
13719 
13720         if (ImplicitThis) {
13721           QualType ThisType = Context.getPointerType(ImplicitThis->getType());
13722           QualType ThisTypeFromDecl = Context.getPointerType(
13723               cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)->getThisObjectType());
13724 
13725           CheckArgAlignment(OpLoc, FnDecl, "'this'", ThisType,
13726                             ThisTypeFromDecl);
13727         }
13728 
13729         checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray,
13730                   isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(),
13731                   VariadicDoesNotApply);
13732 
13733         ExprResult R = MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
13734         if (R.isInvalid())
13735           return ExprError();
13736 
13737         R = CheckForImmediateInvocation(R, FnDecl);
13738         if (R.isInvalid())
13739           return ExprError();
13740 
13741         // For a rewritten candidate, we've already reversed the arguments
13742         // if needed. Perform the rest of the rewrite now.
13743         if ((Best->RewriteKind & CRK_DifferentOperator) ||
13744             (Op == OO_Spaceship && IsReversed)) {
13745           if (Op == OO_ExclaimEqual) {
13746             assert(ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && "unexpected operator name");
13747             R = CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, UO_LNot, R.get());
13748           } else {
13749             assert(ChosenOp == OO_Spaceship && "unexpected operator name");
13750             llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
13751             Expr *ZeroLiteral =
13752                 IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, OpLoc);
13753 
13754             Sema::CodeSynthesisContext Ctx;
13755             Ctx.Kind = Sema::CodeSynthesisContext::RewritingOperatorAsSpaceship;
13756             Ctx.Entity = FnDecl;
13757             pushCodeSynthesisContext(Ctx);
13758 
13759             R = CreateOverloadedBinOp(
13760                 OpLoc, Opc, Fns, IsReversed ? ZeroLiteral : R.get(),
13761                 IsReversed ? R.get() : ZeroLiteral, PerformADL,
13762                 /*AllowRewrittenCandidates=*/false);
13763 
13764             popCodeSynthesisContext();
13765           }
13766           if (R.isInvalid())
13767             return ExprError();
13768         } else {
13769           assert(ChosenOp == Op && "unexpected operator name");
13770         }
13771 
13772         // Make a note in the AST if we did any rewriting.
13773         if (Best->RewriteKind != CRK_None)
13774           R = new (Context) CXXRewrittenBinaryOperator(R.get(), IsReversed);
13775 
13776         return R;
13777       } else {
13778         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
13779         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
13780         // operator node.
13781         ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion(
13782             Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0],
13783             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13784         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
13785           return ExprError();
13786         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
13787 
13788         ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion(
13789             Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1],
13790             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13791         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
13792           return ExprError();
13793         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
13794         break;
13795       }
13796     }
13797 
13798     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
13799       // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
13800       //   If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
13801       //   viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
13802       //   built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
13803       if (Opc == BO_Comma)
13804         break;
13805 
13806       // When defaulting an 'operator<=>', we can try to synthesize a three-way
13807       // compare result using '==' and '<'.
13808       if (DefaultedFn && Opc == BO_Cmp) {
13809         ExprResult E = BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(OpLoc, Fns, Args[0],
13810                                                           Args[1], DefaultedFn);
13811         if (E.isInvalid() || E.isUsable())
13812           return E;
13813       }
13814 
13815       // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assignment
13816       // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
13817       // no overloaded assignment operator found
13818       ExprResult Result = ExprError();
13819       StringRef OpcStr = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc);
13820       auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
13821                                                    Args, OpLoc);
13822       if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
13823           Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
13824         Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
13825              << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13826              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13827         if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) {
13828           Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete)
13829             << Args[0]->getType()
13830             << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13831         }
13832       } else {
13833         // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
13834         // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
13835         // defined too late to be candidates.
13836         if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
13837           // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
13838           return ExprError();
13839 
13840         // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
13841         // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
13842         Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13843       }
13844       assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
13845              "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
13846       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Args, Cands, OpcStr, OpLoc);
13847       return Result;
13848     }
13849 
13850     case OR_Ambiguous:
13851       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13852           PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
13853                                          << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13854                                          << Args[0]->getType()
13855                                          << Args[1]->getType()
13856                                          << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
13857                                          << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
13858           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13859           OpLoc);
13860       return ExprError();
13861 
13862     case OR_Deleted:
13863       if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
13864         FunctionDecl *DeletedFD = Best->Function;
13865         DefaultedFunctionKind DFK = getDefaultedFunctionKind(DeletedFD);
13866         if (DFK.isSpecialMember()) {
13867           Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
13868             << Args[0]->getType() << DFK.asSpecialMember();
13869         } else {
13870           assert(DFK.isComparison());
13871           Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_comparison)
13872             << Args[0]->getType() << DeletedFD;
13873         }
13874 
13875         // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
13876         // explain why it's deleted.
13877         NoteDeletedFunction(DeletedFD);
13878         return ExprError();
13879       }
13880       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13881           PartialDiagnosticAt(
13882               OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
13883                          << getOperatorSpelling(Best->Function->getDeclName()
13884                                                     .getCXXOverloadedOperator())
13885                          << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
13886                          << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
13887           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13888           OpLoc);
13889       return ExprError();
13890   }
13891 
13892   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
13893   return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13894 }
13895 
13896 ExprResult Sema::BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(
13897     SourceLocation OpLoc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
13898     FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) {
13899   const ComparisonCategoryInfo *Info =
13900       Context.CompCategories.lookupInfoForType(DefaultedFn->getReturnType());
13901   // If we're not producing a known comparison category type, we can't
13902   // synthesize a three-way comparison. Let the caller diagnose this.
13903   if (!Info)
13904     return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr);
13905 
13906   // If we ever want to perform this synthesis more generally, we will need to
13907   // apply the temporary materialization conversion to the operands.
13908   assert(LHS->isGLValue() && RHS->isGLValue() &&
13909          "cannot use prvalue expressions more than once");
13910   Expr *OrigLHS = LHS;
13911   Expr *OrigRHS = RHS;
13912 
13913   // Replace the LHS and RHS with OpaqueValueExprs; we're going to refer to
13914   // each of them multiple times below.
13915   LHS = new (Context)
13916       OpaqueValueExpr(LHS->getExprLoc(), LHS->getType(), LHS->getValueKind(),
13917                       LHS->getObjectKind(), LHS);
13918   RHS = new (Context)
13919       OpaqueValueExpr(RHS->getExprLoc(), RHS->getType(), RHS->getValueKind(),
13920                       RHS->getObjectKind(), RHS);
13921 
13922   ExprResult Eq = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_EQ, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, true,
13923                                         DefaultedFn);
13924   if (Eq.isInvalid())
13925     return ExprError();
13926 
13927   ExprResult Less = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, LHS, RHS, true,
13928                                           true, DefaultedFn);
13929   if (Less.isInvalid())
13930     return ExprError();
13931 
13932   ExprResult Greater;
13933   if (Info->isPartial()) {
13934     Greater = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, RHS, LHS, true, true,
13935                                     DefaultedFn);
13936     if (Greater.isInvalid())
13937       return ExprError();
13938   }
13939 
13940   // Form the list of comparisons we're going to perform.
13941   struct Comparison {
13942     ExprResult Cmp;
13943     ComparisonCategoryResult Result;
13944   } Comparisons[4] =
13945   { {Eq, Info->isStrong() ? ComparisonCategoryResult::Equal
13946                           : ComparisonCategoryResult::Equivalent},
13947     {Less, ComparisonCategoryResult::Less},
13948     {Greater, ComparisonCategoryResult::Greater},
13949     {ExprResult(), ComparisonCategoryResult::Unordered},
13950   };
13951 
13952   int I = Info->isPartial() ? 3 : 2;
13953 
13954   // Combine the comparisons with suitable conditional expressions.
13955   ExprResult Result;
13956   for (; I >= 0; --I) {
13957     // Build a reference to the comparison category constant.
13958     auto *VI = Info->lookupValueInfo(Comparisons[I].Result);
13959     // FIXME: Missing a constant for a comparison category. Diagnose this?
13960     if (!VI)
13961       return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr);
13962     ExprResult ThisResult =
13963         BuildDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(), VI->VD);
13964     if (ThisResult.isInvalid())
13965       return ExprError();
13966 
13967     // Build a conditional unless this is the final case.
13968     if (Result.get()) {
13969       Result = ActOnConditionalOp(OpLoc, OpLoc, Comparisons[I].Cmp.get(),
13970                                   ThisResult.get(), Result.get());
13971       if (Result.isInvalid())
13972         return ExprError();
13973     } else {
13974       Result = ThisResult;
13975     }
13976   }
13977 
13978   // Build a PseudoObjectExpr to model the rewriting of an <=> operator, and to
13979   // bind the OpaqueValueExprs before they're (repeatedly) used.
13980   Expr *SyntacticForm = BinaryOperator::Create(
13981       Context, OrigLHS, OrigRHS, BO_Cmp, Result.get()->getType(),
13982       Result.get()->getValueKind(), Result.get()->getObjectKind(), OpLoc,
13983       CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13984   Expr *SemanticForm[] = {LHS, RHS, Result.get()};
13985   return PseudoObjectExpr::Create(Context, SyntacticForm, SemanticForm, 2);
13986 }
13987 
13988 ExprResult
13989 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
13990                                          SourceLocation RLoc,
13991                                          Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
13992   Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
13993   DeclarationName OpName =
13994       Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
13995 
13996   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
13997   // expression.
13998   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
13999 
14000     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
14001     // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
14002     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
14003     OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
14004     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
14005         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>());
14006     if (Fn.isInvalid())
14007       return ExprError();
14008     // Can't add any actual overloads yet
14009 
14010     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn.get(), Args,
14011                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc,
14012                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14013   }
14014 
14015   // Handle placeholders on both operands.
14016   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
14017     return ExprError();
14018   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
14019     return ExprError();
14020 
14021   // Build an empty overload set.
14022   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
14023 
14024   // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
14025 
14026   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
14027   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
14028 
14029   // Add builtin operator candidates.
14030   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
14031 
14032   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14033 
14034   // Perform overload resolution.
14035   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14036   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
14037     case OR_Success: {
14038       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
14039       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
14040 
14041       if (FnDecl) {
14042         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
14043         // operator.
14044 
14045         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
14046 
14047         // Convert the arguments.
14048         CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
14049         ExprResult Arg0 =
14050           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
14051                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
14052         if (Arg0.isInvalid())
14053           return ExprError();
14054         Args[0] = Arg0.get();
14055 
14056         // Convert the arguments.
14057         ExprResult InputInit
14058           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
14059                                                       Context,
14060                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
14061                                       SourceLocation(),
14062                                       Args[1]);
14063         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
14064           return ExprError();
14065 
14066         Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
14067 
14068         // Build the actual expression node.
14069         DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
14070         OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
14071         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
14072                                                   Best->FoundDecl,
14073                                                   Base,
14074                                                   HadMultipleCandidates,
14075                                                   OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
14076                                                   OpLocInfo.getInfo());
14077         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
14078           return ExprError();
14079 
14080         // Determine the result type
14081         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
14082         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14083         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14084 
14085         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
14086             Context, OO_Subscript, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
14087             CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14088         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
14089           return ExprError();
14090 
14091         if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall,
14092                               Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
14093           return ExprError();
14094 
14095         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
14096       } else {
14097         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
14098         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
14099         // operator node.
14100         ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion(
14101             Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0],
14102             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
14103         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
14104           return ExprError();
14105         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
14106 
14107         ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion(
14108             Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1],
14109             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
14110         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
14111           return ExprError();
14112         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
14113 
14114         break;
14115       }
14116     }
14117 
14118     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14119       PartialDiagnostic PD = CandidateSet.empty()
14120           ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
14121              << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
14122              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange())
14123           : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
14124              << Args[0]->getType() << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14125              << Args[1]->getSourceRange());
14126       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PD), *this,
14127                                   OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14128       return ExprError();
14129     }
14130 
14131     case OR_Ambiguous:
14132       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14133           PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
14134                                         << "[]" << Args[0]->getType()
14135                                         << Args[1]->getType()
14136                                         << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14137                                         << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
14138           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14139       return ExprError();
14140 
14141     case OR_Deleted:
14142       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14143           PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
14144                                         << "[]" << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14145                                         << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
14146           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14147       return ExprError();
14148     }
14149 
14150   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
14151   return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
14152 }
14153 
14154 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
14155 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
14156 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
14157 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object
14158 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
14159 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
14160 /// member function.
14161 ExprResult Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
14162                                            SourceLocation LParenLoc,
14163                                            MultiExprArg Args,
14164                                            SourceLocation RParenLoc,
14165                                            bool AllowRecovery) {
14166   assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
14167          MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
14168 
14169   // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
14170   // argument and the member function we're referring to.
14171   Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
14172 
14173   // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
14174   if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14175     assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
14176     assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
14177 
14178     QualType fnType =
14179       op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
14180 
14181     const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14182     QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
14183     ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType());
14184 
14185     // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
14186     // member function we're calling.
14187     Qualifiers funcQuals = proto->getMethodQuals();
14188 
14189     QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
14190     if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
14191       objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
14192     Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
14193 
14194     Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
14195     difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
14196     difference.removeAddressSpace();
14197     if (difference) {
14198       std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
14199       Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
14200         << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
14201         << qualsString
14202         << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
14203     }
14204 
14205     CXXMemberCallExpr *call = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create(
14206         Context, MemExprE, Args, resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc,
14207         CurFPFeatureOverrides(), proto->getNumParams());
14208 
14209     if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(),
14210                             call, nullptr))
14211       return ExprError();
14212 
14213     if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc))
14214       return ExprError();
14215 
14216     if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto))
14217       return ExprError();
14218 
14219     return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
14220   }
14221 
14222   // We only try to build a recovery expr at this level if we can preserve
14223   // the return type, otherwise we return ExprError() and let the caller
14224   // recover.
14225   auto BuildRecoveryExpr = [&](QualType Type) {
14226     if (!AllowRecovery)
14227       return ExprError();
14228     std::vector<Expr *> SubExprs = {MemExprE};
14229     llvm::for_each(Args, [&SubExprs](Expr *E) { SubExprs.push_back(E); });
14230     return CreateRecoveryExpr(MemExprE->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs,
14231                               Type);
14232   };
14233   if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr))
14234     return CallExpr::Create(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue,
14235                             RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14236 
14237   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
14238   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
14239     return ExprError();
14240 
14241   MemberExpr *MemExpr;
14242   CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr;
14243   DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public);
14244   NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr;
14245   if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14246     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
14247     Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
14248     FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
14249     Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
14250     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14251   } else {
14252     UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
14253     Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
14254 
14255     QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
14256     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
14257       = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
14258                             : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
14259 
14260     // Add overload candidates
14261     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14262                                       OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14263 
14264     // FIXME: avoid copy.
14265     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
14266     if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
14267       UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
14268       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
14269     }
14270 
14271     for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
14272            E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
14273 
14274       NamedDecl *Func = *I;
14275       CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
14276       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
14277         Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
14278 
14279 
14280       // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
14281       if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
14282         AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args,
14283                              CandidateSet,
14284                              /*SuppressUserConversions*/ false);
14285       } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
14286         // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
14287         // non-template member function.
14288         if (TemplateArgs)
14289           continue;
14290 
14291         AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
14292                            ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
14293                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
14294       } else {
14295         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
14296             cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC,
14297             TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
14298             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
14299       }
14300     }
14301 
14302     DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
14303 
14304     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14305 
14306     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14307     bool Succeeded = false;
14308     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getBeginLoc(),
14309                                             Best)) {
14310     case OR_Success:
14311       Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14312       FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
14313       CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
14314       if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
14315         break;
14316       // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template
14317       // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
14318       // called on both.
14319       // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
14320       // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
14321       // being used.
14322       if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
14323                       DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
14324         break;
14325       Succeeded = true;
14326       break;
14327 
14328     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
14329       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14330           PartialDiagnosticAt(
14331               UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14332               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
14333                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14334           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14335       break;
14336     case OR_Ambiguous:
14337       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14338           PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14339                               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
14340                                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14341           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14342       break;
14343     case OR_Deleted:
14344       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14345           PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14346                               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
14347                                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14348           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14349       break;
14350     }
14351     // Overload resolution fails, try to recover.
14352     if (!Succeeded)
14353       return BuildRecoveryExpr(chooseRecoveryType(CandidateSet, &Best));
14354 
14355     MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
14356 
14357     // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
14358     // non-member call based on that function.
14359     if (Method->isStatic()) {
14360       return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args,
14361                                    RParenLoc);
14362     }
14363 
14364     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
14365   }
14366 
14367   QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType();
14368   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
14369   ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14370 
14371   assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
14372   const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14373   CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create(
14374       Context, MemExprE, Args, ResultType, VK, RParenLoc,
14375       CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Proto->getNumParams());
14376 
14377   // Check for a valid return type.
14378   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14379                           TheCall, Method))
14380     return BuildRecoveryExpr(ResultType);
14381 
14382   // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
14383   // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
14384   // it was done at lookup.
14385   if (!Method->isStatic()) {
14386     ExprResult ObjectArg =
14387       PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
14388                                           FoundDecl, Method);
14389     if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
14390       return ExprError();
14391     MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get());
14392   }
14393 
14394   // Convert the rest of the arguments
14395   if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args,
14396                               RParenLoc))
14397     return BuildRecoveryExpr(ResultType);
14398 
14399   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
14400 
14401   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
14402     return ExprError();
14403 
14404   // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading
14405   // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do
14406   // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors.
14407   if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14408     if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr =
14409             CheckEnableIf(Method, LParenLoc, Args, true)) {
14410       Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(),
14411            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
14412           << Method << Method->getSourceRange();
14413       Diag(Method->getLocation(),
14414            diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
14415           << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
14416       return ExprError();
14417     }
14418   }
14419 
14420   if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
14421        isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
14422       TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
14423     const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
14424 
14425     if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) &&
14426         MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) {
14427       Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(),
14428            diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
14429           << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
14430           << MD->getParent();
14431 
14432       Diag(MD->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
14433       if (getLangOpts().AppleKext)
14434         Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext)
14435             << MD->getParent() << MD->getDeclName();
14436     }
14437   }
14438 
14439   if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD =
14440           dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) {
14441     // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode.
14442     bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext;
14443     CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), /*IsDelete=*/false,
14444                          CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true,
14445                          MemExpr->getMemberLoc());
14446   }
14447 
14448   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall),
14449                                      TheCall->getMethodDecl());
14450 }
14451 
14452 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
14453 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
14454 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
14455 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
14456 ExprResult
14457 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
14458                                    SourceLocation LParenLoc,
14459                                    MultiExprArg Args,
14460                                    SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
14461   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
14462     return ExprError();
14463   ExprResult Object = Obj;
14464 
14465   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
14466   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
14467     return ExprError();
14468 
14469   assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() &&
14470          "Requires object type argument");
14471 
14472   // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
14473   //  If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
14474   //  evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
14475   //  candidate functions includes at least the function call
14476   //  operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
14477   //  ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
14478   //  (E).operator().
14479   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc,
14480                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
14481   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
14482 
14483   if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
14484                           diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
14485     return true;
14486 
14487   const auto *Record = Object.get()->getType()->castAs<RecordType>();
14488   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
14489   LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
14490   R.suppressDiagnostics();
14491 
14492   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
14493        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
14494     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
14495                        Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet,
14496                        /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false);
14497   }
14498 
14499   // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
14500   //   In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
14501   //   declared in T of the form
14502   //
14503   //        operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
14504   //
14505   //   where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
14506   //   greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
14507   //   denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
14508   //   R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
14509   //   (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
14510   //   of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
14511   //   is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
14512   //   surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
14513   //   functions for each conversion function declared in an
14514   //   accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
14515   //   within T by another intervening declaration.
14516   const auto &Conversions =
14517       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
14518   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
14519     NamedDecl *D = *I;
14520     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
14521     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
14522       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
14523 
14524     // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
14525     // surrogates.
14526     if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
14527       continue;
14528 
14529     CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
14530     if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
14531       // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
14532       // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
14533       QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
14534       if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
14535         ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
14536 
14537       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
14538       {
14539         AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
14540                               Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet);
14541       }
14542     }
14543   }
14544 
14545   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14546 
14547   // Perform overload resolution.
14548   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14549   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14550                                           Best)) {
14551   case OR_Success:
14552     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
14553     // below.
14554     break;
14555 
14556   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14557     PartialDiagnostic PD =
14558         CandidateSet.empty()
14559             ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
14560                << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
14561                << Object.get()->getSourceRange())
14562             : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
14563                << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange());
14564     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14565         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), PD), *this,
14566         OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14567     break;
14568   }
14569   case OR_Ambiguous:
14570     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14571         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14572                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
14573                                 << Object.get()->getType()
14574                                 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()),
14575         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14576     break;
14577 
14578   case OR_Deleted:
14579     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14580         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14581                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
14582                                 << Object.get()->getType()
14583                                 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()),
14584         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14585     break;
14586   }
14587 
14588   if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
14589     return true;
14590 
14591   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14592 
14593   if (Best->Function == nullptr) {
14594     // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
14595     // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
14596     CXXConversionDecl *Conv
14597       = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
14598                          Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
14599 
14600     CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr,
14601                               Best->FoundDecl);
14602     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
14603       return ExprError();
14604     assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
14605              "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!");
14606     // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
14607     // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
14608     // on the object argument, then let BuildCallExpr finish the job.
14609 
14610     // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
14611     // and then call it.
14612     ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
14613                                              Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
14614     if (Call.isInvalid())
14615       return ExprError();
14616     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
14617     Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(
14618         Context, Call.get()->getType(), CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(),
14619         nullptr, VK_RValue, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14620 
14621     return BuildCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc);
14622   }
14623 
14624   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
14625 
14626   // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
14627   // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
14628   // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
14629   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14630 
14631   // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
14632   if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
14633     return ExprError();
14634 
14635   const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14636   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
14637 
14638   DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
14639                Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
14640   OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
14641   ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
14642                                            Obj, HadMultipleCandidates,
14643                                            OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
14644                                            OpLocInfo.getInfo());
14645   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
14646     return true;
14647 
14648   // The number of argument slots to allocate in the call. If we have default
14649   // arguments we need to allocate space for them as well. We additionally
14650   // need one more slot for the object parameter.
14651   unsigned NumArgsSlots = 1 + std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams);
14652 
14653   // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object
14654   // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list).
14655   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(NumArgsSlots);
14656 
14657   bool IsError = false;
14658 
14659   // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
14660   ExprResult ObjRes =
14661     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
14662                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
14663   if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
14664     IsError = true;
14665   else
14666     Object = ObjRes;
14667   MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
14668 
14669   // Check the argument types.
14670   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) {
14671     Expr *Arg;
14672     if (i < Args.size()) {
14673       Arg = Args[i];
14674 
14675       // Pass the argument.
14676 
14677       ExprResult InputInit
14678         = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
14679                                                     Context,
14680                                                     Method->getParamDecl(i)),
14681                                     SourceLocation(), Arg);
14682 
14683       IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
14684       Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
14685     } else {
14686       ExprResult DefArg
14687         = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
14688       if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
14689         IsError = true;
14690         break;
14691       }
14692 
14693       Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>();
14694     }
14695 
14696     MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg;
14697   }
14698 
14699   // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
14700   if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
14701     // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
14702     for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) {
14703       ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
14704                                                         nullptr);
14705       IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
14706       MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg.get();
14707     }
14708   }
14709 
14710   if (IsError)
14711     return true;
14712 
14713   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
14714 
14715   // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly owned.
14716   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
14717   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14718   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14719 
14720   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
14721       Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc,
14722       CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14723 
14724   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method))
14725     return true;
14726 
14727   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
14728     return true;
14729 
14730   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), Method);
14731 }
14732 
14733 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
14734 ///  (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
14735 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
14736 ExprResult
14737 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc,
14738                                bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) {
14739   assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
14740          "left-hand side must have class type");
14741 
14742   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
14743     return ExprError();
14744 
14745   SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
14746 
14747   // C++ [over.ref]p1:
14748   //
14749   //   [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
14750   //   for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
14751   //   the operator is selected as the best match function by the
14752   //   overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
14753   DeclarationName OpName =
14754     Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
14755   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
14756 
14757   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
14758                           diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
14759     return ExprError();
14760 
14761   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
14762   LookupQualifiedName(R, Base->getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
14763   R.suppressDiagnostics();
14764 
14765   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
14766        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
14767     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
14768                        None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false);
14769   }
14770 
14771   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14772 
14773   // Perform overload resolution.
14774   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14775   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
14776   case OR_Success:
14777     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
14778     break;
14779 
14780   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14781     auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
14782     if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
14783       QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
14784       if (NoArrowOperatorFound) {
14785         // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a
14786         // diagnostic, as requested.
14787         *NoArrowOperatorFound = true;
14788         return ExprError();
14789       }
14790       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
14791         << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange();
14792       if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) {
14793         Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
14794           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
14795       }
14796     } else
14797       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
14798         << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
14799     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Base, Cands);
14800     return ExprError();
14801   }
14802   case OR_Ambiguous:
14803     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14804         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
14805                                        << "->" << Base->getType()
14806                                        << Base->getSourceRange()),
14807         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Base);
14808     return ExprError();
14809 
14810   case OR_Deleted:
14811     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14812         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
14813                                        << "->" << Base->getSourceRange()),
14814         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
14815     return ExprError();
14816   }
14817 
14818   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
14819 
14820   // Convert the object parameter.
14821   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14822   ExprResult BaseResult =
14823     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
14824                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
14825   if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
14826     return ExprError();
14827   Base = BaseResult.get();
14828 
14829   // Build the operator call.
14830   ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
14831                                             Base, HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
14832   if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
14833     return ExprError();
14834 
14835   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
14836   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14837   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14838   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
14839       CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), Base,
14840                                   ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14841 
14842   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method))
14843     return ExprError();
14844 
14845   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall,
14846                         Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
14847     return ExprError();
14848 
14849   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
14850 }
14851 
14852 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
14853 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
14854 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
14855                                           DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
14856                                           ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
14857                                           SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
14858                                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
14859   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
14860 
14861   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc,
14862                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14863   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet,
14864                                  TemplateArgs);
14865 
14866   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14867 
14868   // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
14869   // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
14870   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14871   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
14872   case OR_Success:
14873   case OR_Deleted:
14874     break;
14875 
14876   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
14877     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14878         PartialDiagnosticAt(UDSuffixLoc,
14879                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
14880                                 << R.getLookupName()),
14881         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14882     return ExprError();
14883 
14884   case OR_Ambiguous:
14885     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14886         PartialDiagnosticAt(R.getNameLoc(), PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
14887                                                 << R.getLookupName()),
14888         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14889     return ExprError();
14890   }
14891 
14892   FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
14893   ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
14894                                         nullptr, HadMultipleCandidates,
14895                                         SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
14896                                         SuffixInfo.getInfo());
14897   if (Fn.isInvalid())
14898     return true;
14899 
14900   // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
14901   // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
14902   Expr *ConvArgs[2];
14903   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
14904     ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
14905       InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
14906       SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
14907     if (InputInit.isInvalid())
14908       return true;
14909     ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get();
14910   }
14911 
14912   QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType();
14913   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14914   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14915 
14916   UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = UserDefinedLiteral::Create(
14917       Context, Fn.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), ResultTy,
14918       VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14919 
14920   if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
14921     return ExprError();
14922 
14923   if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr))
14924     return ExprError();
14925 
14926   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL), FD);
14927 }
14928 
14929 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
14930 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
14931 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
14932 /// dependent lookup.
14933 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
14934 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
14935 /// is returned.
14936 Sema::ForRangeStatus
14937 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc,
14938                                 SourceLocation RangeLoc,
14939                                 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
14940                                 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
14941                                 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
14942                                 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
14943   Scope *S = nullptr;
14944 
14945   CandidateSet->clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14946   if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
14947     ExprResult MemberRef =
14948         BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
14949                                  /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
14950                                  /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
14951                                  /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr,
14952                                  MemberLookup,
14953                                  /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S);
14954     if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
14955       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14956       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14957     }
14958     *CallExpr = BuildCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr);
14959     if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
14960       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14961       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14962     }
14963   } else {
14964     ExprResult FnR = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(/*NamingClass=*/nullptr,
14965                                                 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
14966                                                 NameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>());
14967     if (FnR.isInvalid())
14968       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14969     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(FnR.get());
14970 
14971     bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc,
14972                                                     CandidateSet, CallExpr);
14973     if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
14974       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14975       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
14976     }
14977     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14978     OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
14979         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best);
14980 
14981     if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
14982       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14983       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
14984     }
14985     *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range,
14986                                          Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best,
14987                                          OverloadResult,
14988                                          /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
14989     if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
14990       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14991       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14992     }
14993   }
14994   return FRS_Success;
14995 }
14996 
14997 
14998 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
14999 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
15000 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
15001 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
15002 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
15003 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
15004                                            FunctionDecl *Fn) {
15005   if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
15006     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
15007                                                    Found, Fn);
15008     if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
15009       return PE;
15010 
15011     return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
15012   }
15013 
15014   if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
15015     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
15016                                                    Found, Fn);
15017     assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
15018                                SubExpr->getType()) &&
15019            "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
15020     assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
15021     if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
15022       return ICE;
15023 
15024     return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(),
15025                                     SubExpr, nullptr, ICE->getValueKind(),
15026                                     CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15027   }
15028 
15029   if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) {
15030     if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) {
15031       Expr *SubExpr =
15032           FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn);
15033       if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr())
15034         return GSE;
15035 
15036       // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic
15037       // selection expression.
15038       ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs();
15039       SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end());
15040       unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex();
15041       AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr;
15042 
15043       return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(
15044           Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(),
15045           GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(),
15046           GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(),
15047           ResultIdx);
15048     }
15049     // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic
15050     // selection expression.
15051     return GSE;
15052   }
15053 
15054   if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
15055     assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
15056            "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
15057     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
15058       if (Method->isStatic()) {
15059         // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
15060         // from non-member functions.
15061       } else {
15062         // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an
15063         // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
15064         // or template.
15065         Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
15066                                                        Found, Fn);
15067         if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
15068           return UnOp;
15069 
15070         assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
15071                && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
15072         assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
15073                && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
15074 
15075         // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
15076         // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
15077         // appropriate pointer to member type.
15078         QualType ClassType
15079           = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
15080         QualType MemPtrType
15081           = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
15082         // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now.
15083         if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
15084           (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType);
15085 
15086         return UnaryOperator::Create(
15087             Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
15088             UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15089       }
15090     }
15091     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
15092                                                    Found, Fn);
15093     if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
15094       return UnOp;
15095 
15096     return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
15097                                  Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
15098                                  VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, UnOp->getOperatorLoc(),
15099                                  false, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15100   }
15101 
15102   if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
15103     // FIXME: avoid copy.
15104     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
15105     if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
15106       ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
15107       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
15108     }
15109 
15110     DeclRefExpr *DRE =
15111         BuildDeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, ULE->getNameInfo(),
15112                          ULE->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(),
15113                          ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs);
15114     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
15115     return DRE;
15116   }
15117 
15118   if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
15119     // FIXME: avoid copy.
15120     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
15121     if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
15122       MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
15123       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
15124     }
15125 
15126     Expr *Base;
15127 
15128     // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
15129     // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
15130     if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
15131       if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
15132         DeclRefExpr *DRE = BuildDeclRefExpr(
15133             Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, MemExpr->getNameInfo(),
15134             MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(),
15135             MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs);
15136         DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
15137         return DRE;
15138       } else {
15139         SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
15140         if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
15141           Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
15142         Base =
15143             BuildCXXThisExpr(Loc, MemExpr->getBaseType(), /*IsImplicit=*/true);
15144       }
15145     } else
15146       Base = MemExpr->getBase();
15147 
15148     ExprValueKind valueKind;
15149     QualType type;
15150     if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
15151       valueKind = VK_LValue;
15152       type = Fn->getType();
15153     } else {
15154       valueKind = VK_RValue;
15155       type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
15156     }
15157 
15158     return BuildMemberExpr(
15159         Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(),
15160         MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found,
15161         /*HadMultipleCandidates=*/true, MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
15162         type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary, TemplateArgs);
15163   }
15164 
15165   llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
15166 }
15167 
15168 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
15169                                                 DeclAccessPair Found,
15170                                                 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
15171   return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn);
15172 }
15173